Tragedy at Ravensthorpe

By J. J. Connington

The Project Gutenberg eBook of Tragedy at Ravensthorpe
    
This ebook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms
of the Project Gutenberg License included with this ebook or online
at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States,
you will have to check the laws of the country where you are located
before using this eBook.

Title: Tragedy at Ravensthorpe

Author: J. J. Connington

Release date: February 18, 2025 [eBook #75407]

Language: English

Original publication: New York, NY: Grosset & Dunlap, 1927

Credits: Brian Raiter


*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK TRAGEDY AT RAVENSTHORPE ***


Tragedy at Ravensthorpe

by J. J. Connington

Published February, 1928 by Grosset & Dunlap (New York)
Copyright, 1927, 1928, by Little, Brown, and Company



CONTENTS

    I. The Fairy Houses
   II. Mr. Polegate’s Sense of Humour
  III. The Theft at the Masked Ball
   IV. The Chase in the Woods
    V. Sir Clinton in the Museum
   VI. Mr. Foss’s Explanation
  VII. What Was in the Lake
 VIII. The Murder in the Museum
   IX. The Muramasa Sword
    X. The Shot in the Clearing
   XI. Underground Ravensthorpe
  XII. Chuchundra’s Body
 XIII. The Otophone
  XIV. The Second Chase in the Woods
   XV. Sir Clinton’s Solution



NOTE

The characters, places, and events described in this book are entirely
imaginary and have no connection, either direct or indirect, with any
real persons, places, or events.



CHAPTER I

The Fairy Houses

“Got fixed up in your new house yet, Sir Clinton?” asked Cecil
Chacewater, as they sauntered together up one of the paths in the
Ravensthorpe grounds. “It must be a bit of a change from South
Africa—settling down in this backwater.”

Sir Clinton Driffield, the new Chief Constable of the county, nodded
affirmatively in reply to the question.

“One manages to be fairly comfortable; and it’s certainly been less
trouble to fit up than it would have been if I’d taken a bigger place.
Not that I don’t envy you people at Ravensthorpe,” he added, glancing
round at the long front of the house behind him. “You’ve plenty of
elbow-room in that castle of yours.”

Cecil made no reply; and they paced on for a minute or more before Sir
Clinton again spoke.

“It’s a curious thing, Cecil, that although I knew your father so
well, I never happened to come down here to Ravensthorpe. He often
asked me to stay; and I wanted to see his collection; but somehow we
never seemed able to fix on a time that suited us both. It was at the
house in Onslow Square that I always saw you, so this is all fresh
ground to me. It’s rather like the irony of fate that my first post
since I came home should be in the very district I couldn’t find time
to visit when your father was alive.”

Cecil Chacewater agreed with a gesture.

“I was very glad when I saw you’d been appointed. I wondered if you’d
know me again after all that time; but I thought we’d better bring
ourselves to your notice in case we could be of any help
here—introduce you to people, and all that sort of thing, you know.”

“I hardly recognized you when you turned up the other day,” Sir
Clinton admitted frankly. “You were a kiddie when I went off to take
that police post in South Africa; and somehow or other I never seem to
have run across you on any of my trips home on leave. It must have
been ten years since I’d seen you.”

“I don’t wonder you didn’t place me at once. Ten years makes a lot of
difference at my advanced age. But you don’t look a bit changed. I
recognized you straight off, as soon as I saw you.”

“What age are you now?” asked Sir Clinton.

“About twenty-three,” Cecil replied. “Maurice is twenty-five, and
Joan’s just on the edge of twenty-one.”

“I suppose she must be,” Sir Clinton confirmed.

A thought seemed to cross his mind.

“By the way, this masked ball, I take it, is for Joan’s
coming-of-age?”

“You got an invitation? Right! I’ve nothing to do with that part of
the business.” Then, answering Sir Clinton’s inquiry: “Yes, that’s so.
She wanted a spree of some sort; and she generally gets what she
wants, you know. You’ll hardly know _her_ when you see her. She’s shot
up out of all recognition from the kid you knew before you went away.”

“She used to be pretty as a school-girl.”

“Oh, she hasn’t fallen off in that direction. You must come to this
show of hers. She’ll be awfully pleased if you do. She looks on you as
a kind of unofficial uncle, you know.”

Sir Clinton’s expression showed that he appreciated the indirect
compliment.

“I’m highly flattered. She’s the only one of you who took the trouble
to write to me from time to time when I was out yonder. All my
Ravensthorpe news came through her.”

Cecil was rather discomfited by this reminder. He changed the subject
abruptly.

“I suppose you’ll come as Sherlock Holmes? Joan’s laid down that every
one must act up to their costume, whatever it is; and Sherlock
wouldn’t give you much trouble after all your detective experience.
You’d only have to snoop round and pick up clues and make people
uncomfortable with deductions.”

Sir Clinton seemed amused by the idea.

“A pretty programme! Something like this, I suppose?” he demanded, and
gave a faintly caricatured imitation of the Holmes mannerisms.

“By Jove, you know, that’s awfully good!” Cecil commented, rather
taken aback by the complete change in Sir Clinton’s voice and gait.
“You ought to do it. You’d get first prize easily.”

Sir Clinton shook his head as he resumed his natural guise.

“The mask wouldn’t cover my moustache; and I draw the line at shaving
that off, even in a good cause. Besides, a Chief Constable can’t go
running about disguised as Sherlock Holmes. Rather bad taste, dragging
one’s trade into one’s amusements. No, I’ll come as something quite
unostentatious: a pillar-box or an Invisible Man, or a spook,
probably.”

“I forgot,” Cecil hastened to say, apologetically, “I shouldn’t have
asked you about your costume. Joan’s very strong on some fancy
regulation she’s made that no one is to know beforehand what anyone
else is wearing. She wants the prize awarding to be absolutely
unbiased. So you’d better not tell me what you’re going to do.”

Sir Clinton glanced at him with a faint twinkle in his eye.

“That’s precisely what I’ve been doing for the last minute or two,” he
said, dryly.

“What do you mean?” Cecil asked, looking puzzled. “You haven’t told me
anything.”

“Exactly.”

Cecil was forced to smile.

“No harm done,” he admitted. “You gave nothing away.”

“It’s a very useful habit in my line of business.”

But Sir Clinton’s interest in the approaching masked ball was
apparently not yet exhausted.

“Large crowd coming?” he asked.

“Fairish, I believe. Most of the neighbours, I suppose. We’re putting
up a few people for the night, of course; and there are three or four
visitors on the premises already. It should be quite a decent show. I
can’t give you even rough numbers, for Joan’s taken the invitation
side of the thing entirely into her own hands—most mysterious about
it, too. Hush! Hush! Very Secret! and all that kind of thing. She
won’t even let us see her lists for fear of making it too easy to
recognize people; so she’s had to arrange the catering side of the
thing on her own as well.”

“She always was an independent kind of person,” Sir Clinton
volunteered.

Cecil took no notice of the interjection.

“If you ask me,” he went on, “I think she’s a bit besotted with this
incognito notion. She doesn’t realize that half the gang can be
spotted at once by their walk, and the other half will give themselves
away as soon as they get animated and begin to jabber freely. But it’s
her show, you know, so it’s no use any one else butting in with
criticisms and spoiling her fun before it begins.”

Sir Clinton nodded his assent; but for a moment or two he seemed to be
preoccupied with some line of thought which Cecil’s words had started
in his mind. Suddenly, however, something caught his eye and diverted
his attention to external things.

“What’s that weird thing over there?” he asked. As he spoke, he
pointed to an object a little way off the path on which they were
standing. It was a tiny building about a yard in height and a couple
of yards or more in length. At the first glance it seemed like a
bungalow reduced to the scale of a large doll’s house; but closer
inspection showed that it was windowless, though ventilation of a sort
appeared to have been provided. A miniature door closed the entrance,
through which a full-grown man could gain admittance only by lying
flat on the ground and wriggling with some difficulty through the
narrow opening provided.

“That?” Cecil answered carelessly. “Oh, that’s one of the Fairy
Houses, you know. They’re a sort of local curiosity. No matter where
you are, you’ll find one of them within a couple of hundred yards of
you, anywhere in the grounds.”

“Only in the grounds? Aren’t there any outside the estate?” inquired
Sir Clinton. “At the first glance I took it for some sort of
archæological affair.”

“They’re old enough, I dare say,” Cecil admitted, indifferently. “A
century, or a century and a half, or perhaps even more. They’re purely
a Ravensthorpe product. I’ve never seen one of them outside the
boundary.”

Sir Clinton left the path and made a closer examination of the tiny
hut; but it presented very few points of interest in itself. Out of
curiosity, he turned the handle of the door and found it moved easily.

“You seem to keep the locks and hinges oiled,” he said, with some
surprise.

Pushing the door open, he stooped down and glanced inside.

“Very spic and span. You keep them in good repair, evidently.”

“Oh, one of the gardeners has the job of looking after them,” Cecil
explained, without showing much interest.

“I’ve never seen anything of the sort before. They might be Picts’
dwellings, or something of that kind; but why keep them in repair?
And, of course, they’re not prehistoric at all. They’re comparatively
modern, from the way they’re put together. What are they?”

“Ask me another,” said Cecil, who seemed bored by the subject.
“They’re an ancestral legacy, or an heirloom, or a tenant’s
improvement, or whatever you like to call it. Clause in the will each
time, to provide for them being kept in good repair, and so forth.”

Sir Clinton seemed to prick up his ears when he heard of this
provision, though his tone showed only languid interest when he put
his next inquiry.

“Anything at the back of it all? It seems a rum sort of business.”

“The country-people round about here will supply you with all the
information you can believe about it—and a lot you’re not likely to
swallow, too. By their way of it, Lavington Knoll up there”—he pointed
vaguely to indicate its position—“was the last of the fairy
strongholds hereabouts; and when most of the fairies went away, a few
stayed behind. But these didn’t care much for the old Knoll after
that. Reminded them of past glories and cheery company too much, I
suppose; and so they made a sort of treaty with an ancestor of ours.
He was to provide houses for them, and they were to look after the
general prosperity side of Ravensthorpe.”

Sir Clinton seemed amused by Cecil’s somewhat scornful summary.

“A case of ‘Farewell rewards and fairies,’ it seems, Cecil.”

Then, half to himself, he hummed a few lines of Corbet’s song:

    Witness those rings and roundelayes
      Of theirs, which yet remaine;
    Were footed in queene Maries dayes
      On many a grassy playne.
    But since of late Elizabeth . . .

“Do you go as far back as Elizabeth, here at Ravensthorpe, by any
chance, Cecil?”

“So far as the grounds go, yes. The house was partly destroyed in
Cromwell’s time; and some new bits were built on in place of the old
stuff. But there’s a lot of the old part left yet, in quite good
repair.”

Sir Clinton still seemed interested in the compact with the Fairies.

“Was there any penalty clause in the contract about these Houses?
There’s usually some drawback to these affairs—like the Luck of
Edenhall, for instance.”

“There used to be some legend or other that unless the Fairies found
their houses always in good order, the Family Curse would come home to
roost, one-time. No one believes in that sort of stuff nowadays; but
it’s kept alive by this clause that’s put into every will—a kind of a
family custom, you know, that no one cares to be the first to break.
If you call it a damned old wives’ tale, I shan’t blame you.”

Sir Clinton could not be sure whether Cecil’s indifference in the
matter was natural or assumed; but in any case he thought it tactful
to pursue the subject no further. Closing the door of the Fairy House
again, he made his way back to the path where his companion was
waiting for him.

As the Chief Constable rejoined him, Cecil looked round the horizon
with feeble interest.

“Not much else to show you, I’m afraid,” he said. Then, with an
after-thought: “Care to see rather a good view? The best one
hereabouts is just up above us—through the wood here—if you think it
worth the trouble of the climb. It’s not very far. We’ve plenty of
time before lunch.”

Sir Clinton acquiesced, and they began to mount a further slope in the
path which now led them up through a sparse pine-wood.

“There seems to be a good sound foundation to this path,” the Chief
Constable commented, as they walked on.

“There used to be a carriage-drive, at one time, leading up to the
top. I suppose the old birds used to drive up here and sit out having
tea and admiring the view on fine days. But it’s been neglected for
long enough. Hardly any one goes up to the top now, except once in a
blue moon or else by accident.”

Sir Clinton gave a nod of acquiescence.

“Any one can see the path’s hardly ever used.”

“Just beyond this brow,” Cecil explained as they moved on, “there’s an
old quarry cut in the further side of the hill. It’s a very old place,
rather picturesque nowadays. Most of the stone for Ravensthorpe came
from it in the old days, and during the rebuilding. After that, the
quarry dropped out of use gradually; and finally some one had the
notion of letting water in at the foot of it and having a sort of
model lake there, with the cliff of the quarry at one end of it. We’re
making for the top of the cliff by going this way; and when you get
out of the wood into the open, you’ll find rather a good outlook over
the country.”

A short walk took them through the rest of the pine-wood. On the
further side they came into a belt of open ground beyond which, on a
slight eminence, a little spinney blocked part of the view.

“That’s where we’re making for,” Cecil explained. “The best view-point
is on the other side of these trees. The old birds, a century back,
chose it carefully and did some laying out at the top; so I suppose
they must have been keen on the place.”

As they approached the spinney, Sir Clinton noticed a fence running
down from each side of it. Cecil followed the direction of the Chief
Constable’s glance.

“That’s barbed wire,” he pointed out. “The spinney’s at the top of the
quarry; but there’s a bad drop down towards the hollow on either
side—a dangerous bit, practically precipitous—and so the wire was put
up to prevent any one wandering near the edge and tripping over.”

Cutting through the fringe of trees, they emerged at the top of the
cliff. Here the ground had been levelled and paved. Along the
precipice, a marble balustrade had been erected as a safeguard.
Further back, a curved tier of marble seats faced the view; and here
and there in the line rose pedestals carrying life-sized marble
statues which faced out towards the gulf.

“This is really very elaborate,” Sir Clinton commented. “Evidently
your ancestors liked the view, if they took so much trouble to put up
this affair.”

He moved across the paved space, leaned on the balustrade, and looked
down into the depths.

“I don’t wonder you fenced that in with barbed wire on each side,” he
said. “It’s a nasty drop down there—well over a fifty-foot fall at
least.”

“It’s nearer a hundred, really,” Cecil corrected him. “The height’s a
bit deceptive from here. And a fall into that pool would be no joy, I
can tell you! It’s full of sharp spikes of rock jutting up from the
bottom. You’d get fairly well mauled if you happened to drop on any of
them. You can’t see them for that green stuff in the water; but
they’re all present and correct under the surface.”

Sir Clinton looked down at the weed-grown little lakelet. The dense
green fronds gave the water an unpleasant appearance; and in some tiny
backwaters the surface was covered with a layer of scum.

“Why don’t you get all that stuff cleared out?” he demanded. “It looks
rather beastly. Once you got rid of it you could stock the pool with
trout or perch, easily enough. I see there’s some flow of water
through it from a spring at the east end.”

Cecil seemed to have no interest in the suggestion.

“If you want some fishing,” he said, “we’ve got quite a decent stream
that runs through another part of the grounds. This place used to be
kept in good order; but since the war and all that, you know, the fine
edge has been rather off things hereabouts. It’s in a bad state, right
enough. Just a frog-pond.”

“Is the water deep?” Sir Clinton inquired.

“Oh, ten to fifteen feet in parts. Quite deep just in front of the
cave at the bottom of the cliff below here. We used to have great
times playing robbers and so forth when we were kids. There’s our old
raft at the far end. It was well tarred and I see it’s still afloat.
It was the only way of getting at the cave-mouth, you see.”

He dismissed the subject.

“Suppose we sit down for a while.”

Sir Clinton followed him to one of the marble benches. Before them,
the view of the Ravensthorpe grounds stretched out, closed on the
horizon by a line of woodland. In the foreground, beyond a fence at
the end of the lake, sheep were grazing on some meadow-land.

“One of your ancestors?” inquired Sir Clinton, nodding towards the
nearest statue. “Or merely Phœbus Apollo?”

Cecil turned to glance at the statue.

“I think I’d back your second choice,” he said. “If it was an
ancestor, it must have been one of the ancient Britons. It’s a bit
short of clothes for anything later than that; and even for an ancient
Briton it seems a trifle undressed. No woad, you know.”

He took out his cigarette-case, offered it to Sir Clinton, and then
began to smoke. Sir Clinton seemed to be admiring the view in front of
him for a few minutes; but when he spoke again it was evident that
something more than scenery had been in his mind.

“I’m not altogether easy in my mind over this masked ball of Joan’s.
Speaking as a Chief Constable responsible for the good behaviour of
the district, Cecil, it seems to me that you’re running some risks
over it. A dance is all very well. You know all your guests by
headmark and no one can get in on false pretences. But once you start
masks, it’s a different state of affairs altogether.”

Cecil made no comment; and Sir Clinton smoked in silence for a time
before continuing:

“It’s this craze of Joan’s for anonymity that seems to me to open the
door to all sorts of things. I take it that there’ll be no announcing
of individual guests, because of this incognito stunt of hers. But
unfortunately that means you’ll have to admit any one who chooses to
present himself as Winnie-the-Pooh or Felix the Cat or Father
Christmas. You don’t know who he is. You can’t inquire at the start.
Anybody might get in. Considering the amount of good portable stuff
there is in the collection at Ravensthorpe, do you think it’s quite
desirable to have no check whatever on your guests?”

Cecil seemed struck by this view of the case.

“I never thought of that,” he said. “I suppose we ought to have issued
uniform entrance-tickets, or something of that sort; but the thing
never crossed any of our minds. Somehow, it seems a bit steep to take
precautions against people when one’s inviting them to one’s house.”

“It’s not _invited_ guests I’m thinking about,” Sir Clinton hastened
to explain more definitely. “This affair must have been talked about
all over the countryside. What’s to hinder some enterprising thief
dressing up as a tramp and presenting himself along with the rest?
He’d get in all right. And once he was inside, he might be tempted to
forget the laws of hospitality and help himself. Then, if he made
himself scarce before the unmasking at midnight, he’d get clean away
and leave no trace. See it?”

Cecil nodded affirmatively; but to Sir Clinton’s slight surprise he
did not appear to be much perturbed on the subject. The Chief
Constable seemed to see an explanation of this attitude.

“Perhaps, of course, you’re shutting up the collections for the
evening.”

Cecil shook his head.

“No. Joan insists on having them on view—all of them. It’s a state
occasion for her, you know; and she’s determined to have all the best
of Ravensthorpe for her guests. What she says goes, you know. If she
can’t get her own way by one road she takes another. It’s always
easier to give in to her at once and be done with it. She has such a
way of making one feel a beast if one refuses her anything; and yet
she never seems to get spoiled with it all.”

Sir Clinton seemed rather taken aback by the news about the
collections.

“Well, it’s your funeral, not mine, if anything does happen,” he
admitted.

“Maurice’s—not mine,” Cecil corrected him with a touch of bitterness
which Sir Clinton failed to understand at the moment.

“I’ve nothing to do with Ravensthorpe nowadays,” Cecil went on, after
a pause. “I live there, that’s all. The whole affair went to
Maurice—lock, stock, and barrel—when my father died. I’ve really no
more right in these grounds than you have. I might be kicked out any
day.”

Sir Clinton was puzzled by Cecil’s tone. It was only natural that
Ravensthorpe should go down into the hands of Maurice, since he was
the elder brother. There could be no particular grievance in that. And
yet Cecil’s voice had betrayed something deeper than a mere mild
resentment. The asperity in his last remark had been unmistakable.

For a few minutes Cecil remained silent, staring moodily out at the
landscape. Sir Clinton refrained from interrupting his thoughts. The
matter certainly had excited his curiosity; but until Cecil chose to
say more, there seemed to be no reason for intruding into the private
affairs of the Ravensthorpe household. Even the privileges of an old
friend did not seem to Sir Clinton a sufficient excuse for probing
into family matters.

But the Chief Constable, without any voluntary effort, had the gift of
eliciting confidences without soliciting them. Cecil’s brooding came
to an end and he turned round to face his companion.

“I suppose I’ve said either too much or too little already,” he began.
“I don’t see why I shouldn’t tell you about the affair. It’s nearly
common talk as it is, and you’re sure to hear something about it
sooner or later. You may as well get it first-hand and be done with
it.”

Sir Clinton, having solicited no confidence, contented himself with
merely listening, without offering any vocal encouragement.

“You knew my father well,” Cecil went on, after a short pause in which
he seemed to be arranging his ideas in some definite order. “He was
one of the best, if you like. No one would say a word against him—it’s
the last thing I’d think of doing myself, at any rate.”

Sir Clinton nodded approvingly.

“The bother was,” Cecil continued, “that he judged every one by
himself. He couldn’t understand that any one might not be as straight
as he always was. He never made an allowance for some kinds of human
nature, if you see what I mean. And, another thing, he had a great
notion of the duties of the head of the family. He took them pretty
seriously and he looked after a lot of people who had no claim on him,
really, except that they belonged to the clan.”

“He was always generous, I know,” Sir Clinton confirmed. “And he
always trusted people. Sometimes, perhaps, he overdid it.”

Cecil made a gesture of agreement and continued:

“He overdid it when he drew up his will. Maurice, of course, was bound
to be the next head of the family, once my father had gone; so my
father took it for granted that things would go on just the same. The
head of the family would run the show with an eye to the interests of
the rest of us, and all would be right on the night. That was the
theory of the business, as my father saw it; and he drafted his will
on that basis.”

Cecil sat up suddenly and flung away his cigarette with a vehemence
which betrayed the heat of his feelings.

“That was the theory of the business, as I said. But the practice
wasn’t quite so satisfactory. My father left every penny he had to
Maurice; he left him absolutely every asset; and, of course,
Ravensthorpe’s entailed, so Maurice got that in the normal course.
Joan, my mother, and myself, were left without a farthing to bless
ourselves with. But there was a suggestion in the will—not a legally
binding thing, but merely a sort of informal direction—that Maurice
was to look after us all and give us some sort of income each. I
suppose my father hardly thought it worth while to do more than that.
Being the sort of man he was, he would rely implicitly on Maurice
playing the game, just as he’d have played the game himself—had played
it all his life, you know.”

Sir Clinton showed no desire to offer any comment; and in a moment or
two Cecil went on once more:

“Last year, there was nothing to complain about. Maurice footed our
bills quite decently. He never grumbled over our expenses. Everything
seemed quite sound. It never crossed my mind to get things put on a
business footing. In fact, you know, I’d hardly have had the nerve to
suggest anything of the sort. It would have looked a bit grasping,
wouldn’t it?”

Cecil glanced inquiringly at Sir Clinton, but the Chief Constable
seemed averse from making any comment at this stage. Cecil took his
case from his pocket and lit a fresh cigarette before continuing his
story.

“You don’t remember Una Rainhill, I suppose?”

Sir Clinton shook his head.

“She’s a sort of second cousin of ours,” Cecil explained. “Probably
you never came across her. Besides, she’d hardly be out of the nursery
when you went off to South Africa. Well, she’s grown up now—just about
a year or two younger than Joan. You’ll see her for yourself. She’s
staying with us just now for this coming-of-age of Joan’s.”

Sir Clinton had no great difficulty in guessing, behind Cecil’s
restraint, his actual feelings about the girl. His voice gave him away
if the words did not.

“No use making a long story of it, is there?” Cecil continued. “Both
Maurice and I wanted Una. So did a good many others. But she didn’t
want Maurice. She was quite nice about it. He’d nothing to complain of
in that way. He got no encouragement from her at all. But he wouldn’t
take ‘no’ for an answer. He was really extra keen, and I think he
overdid it instead of making the best of a bad business. And finally
he realized that it was me that he was up against. Una and I aren’t
officially engaged, or anything like that—you’ll see why in a
moment—but it’s a case of two’s company and three’s none; and Maurice
knows he’s Number Three.”

There was more than a tinge of rancour in Cecil’s voice when he came
to this last sentence. Sir Clinton raised his eyebrows slightly. He
did not quite admire this malevolence on the part of the successful
lover against his defeated rival. Cecil apparently noticed the slight
change in the Chief Constable’s expression.

“Wait a minute,” he said. “You haven’t heard it all yet. Before I go
on, just bear in mind that there was plenty of money for all of us in
the family. My father always took it for granted that I’d have enough
to keep me. He’d never thought of my going into business. I’ve got
some sort of turn for writing; and I think he hoped that I’d make some
kind of name as an author. And, of course, with what I supposed was an
assured income behind me, I haven’t hurried much in the way of
publishing my stuff. I could afford to let it lie—or so I thought.”

A slight gesture of Sir Clinton showed his approval of this outlook on
authorship. It seemed to him that Cecil at his age could hardly have
much to tell the world that it didn’t know already; but he had no
intention of expressing any such discouraging views.

“You see how it is,” Cecil continued. “As things stand, I haven’t the
ghost of a chance of earning a decent income for years and years. And
that was the weak joint that Maurice saw and went for—damn him! He
took it upon himself to tell me that I was here more or less on
sufferance. He’d been generous in the past—he actually reminded me of
that!—but he didn’t see how he was to continue to subsidize me
indefinitely. You see his game? If he couldn’t have Una himself, he’d
take care that I shouldn’t have her either. Damned dog-in-the-manger!
That’s a nice sort of brother for you! I wonder what his father would
think about him if he knew of this trick.”

He pitched away the stub of his unfinished cigarette as though with it
he could rid himself of some of his feeling.

“Of course there was friction—I’m putting it mildly—but there was no
open row. My mother’s not in good health and I couldn’t afford to have
her worried over my affairs. So we settled down to some sort of armed
neutrality, although the thing’s more or less evident to most people.
That’s what I meant when I said I might be kicked out any day. It’s
only a question of time, it seems to me. He still thinks that if I
were out of the way he’d have a chance with Una; and sooner or later I
expect him to give me an express-ticket into the wide world. I’m
trying to get some sort of job; but so far I haven’t succeeded in
lighting on anything that seems to offer the slightest prospects. It’s
no pleasure to stay here on sufferance, I can tell you.”

Now that Sir Clinton had received Cecil’s unsolicited confidences, he
hardly knew what to do with them. After all, he reflected, he had
heard only one side of the story; and it was scarcely fair to judge
the case on the strength of an _ex-parte_ statement. It was not quite
the Ravensthorpe which he had expected, he admitted ruefully to
himself as he bent his efforts to bringing Cecil back to normal again.
Money and a girl: the two things that seemed to lie behind most
troubles—and even crimes, as he knew from experience. It seemed an
unkind Fate that had forced these two factors to the front in an
environment where trouble of the kind was the last that might have
been expected. One never knew what this sort of thing might lead to in
the end.

“I’d like to have a look at your father’s collections some time or
other,” he said at last, to change the subject, when he had succeeded
in getting Cecil into a somewhat cooler frame of mind. “I saw a good
many of the things in London from time to time, as he bought them; but
there must be a lot here at Ravensthorpe that will be new to me.
Anything your father bought will be worth looking at. He had wonderful
taste.”

Rather to his vexation, Sir Clinton found that he had only shifted the
conversation from one sore point to another.

“If you want to see anything,” Cecil snapped, “you’d better pay your
visit as soon as you can arrange it. Maurice is going to sell the
lot.”

Sir Clinton was completely taken aback by this news.

“Sell the stuff? What on earth would he want to do that for? He’s got
all the money he needs, surely.”

Cecil dissociated himself from any connection with the matter.

“No business of mine, now. Maurice can do as he likes. Of course, I
hate the idea of all these things of my father’s being sold off when
there seems no need for it; but it’s not my affair. The Maurice boy
isn’t all we thought him; and since he’s come into Ravensthorpe, he
seems to think of very little else but money and how to get more of
it. Anything for the dibs, it appears.”

“But surely he isn’t selling everything. He might get rid of some
minor things; but he’ll hardly break up the whole collection.”

“Every damned thing, Sir Clinton. Why at this very moment he’s got a
Yankee agent—a man Foss—staying at Ravensthorpe and chaffering for the
star pieces of the collections: the Medusa Medallions.”

Sir Clinton shook his head.

“They must be fresh acquisitions since my day. I’ve never even heard
of them.”

“Ever see the picture of Medusa in the Uffizi Gallery? It’s attributed
to Leonardo da Vinci; but some people say it’s only a student’s copy
of the original Leonardo which has disappeared. It seems my father
came across three medallions with almost exactly the same Medusa on
one side and a figure of Perseus on the reverse. And what’s more, he
was able to get documentary proof that these things were really
Leonardo’s own work—strange as it seems. The thing’s quite admitted by
experts. So you can imagine that these Medusas are quite the star
pieces in the museum. And Maurice calmly proposes to sell them to
Kessock, the Yank millionaire; and Kessock has sent this man Foss over
here to negotiate for them.”

“It seems rather a pity to part with them,” Sir Clinton said,
regretfully.

“Maurice doesn’t feel it so,” Cecil retorted, rather bitterly. “He got
a friend of mine, Foxy Polegate, to make him electrotypes of them in
gold—Foxy’s rather good at that sort of thing for an amateur—and
Maurice thinks that the electrotypes will look just as well as the
originals.”

“H’m! Cenotaphs, I suppose,” Sir Clinton commented.

“Quite so. In Memoriam. The real things being buried in the U.S.A.”

Cecil paused for a moment and then concluded:

“You can imagine that none of us like this damned chandlering with
these things that my father spent so much thought over. It’s enough to
make him turn in his grave to have all his favourites scattered—and
just for the sake of Maurice’s infernal miserliness and greed for
cash.”

Sir Clinton rose from his seat and took a last glance at the view
before him.

“What about moving on now?”

Cecil agreed; and they retraced their steps towards the pine-wood. As
they entered the spinney, Sir Clinton noticed another of the Fairy
Houses set back among the trees at a little distance from the path.

“Another of those things?”

Rather to his surprise, Cecil moved over to examine the little
edifice, and bending down opened the door and glanced inside.

“The Fairy’s not at home at present,” he said, standing aside to let
Sir Clinton look in.

Something in Cecil’s voice forced itself on the attention of the Chief
Constable. The words seemed to be pointless; but in the tone there was
an ill-suppressed tinge of what might almost have been malicious glee
at some unexplained jest. Sir Clinton was too wary to follow up this
track, wherever it might lead to. He did not quite like the expression
on Cecil’s face when the remark was made; and he sought for some
transition which would bring them on to a fresh subject.

“You must have some curiosities in Ravensthorpe itself, if parts of it
are as old as they seem to be. Any priest’s holes, or secret passages,
or things of that sort?”

“There are one or two,” Cecil admitted. “But we don’t make a show of
them. In fact, even Joan doesn’t know how to get into them. There’s
some sort of ‘Mistletoe Bough’ story in the family: a girl went into
one of the passages, forgot how to work the spring to get out again,
lost her nerve apparently, and stayed there till she died. It so
happened that she was the only one of the family in the house at the
time, so there was no one to help her out. Since then, we’ve kept the
secret of the springs from our girls. No use running risks.”

“And even Joan hasn’t wheedled it out of you?”

“No, not even Joan. Maurice and I are the only ones who can get into
these places.”

Sir Clinton evidently approved of this.

“Short of opening the passages up altogether, that seems the best
thing to do. One never knows one’s luck. By the way, in an old place
like this you ought to have a stock of family legends. You’ve got
these Fairy Houses. Is there anything else of general interest?”

Cecil seemed to have recovered something of his normal good humour;
and his face betrayed almost a grin of amusement as he replied:

“Oh, yes! We’ve got a family ghost—or so the country-folk say. I’ve
never come across it myself; but it’s common talk that the family
spectre is a White Man who walks in the woods just before the head of
the family dies. All rot, you know. Nobody believes in it, really. But
it’s quite an old-established tradition round about here.”

Sir Clinton laughed.

“You certainly don’t seem to take him very seriously. What about
Family Curses? Are you well supplied?”

“You’d better apply to Maurice if you’re keen on Family Curses. He
seems to have specialized in that branch, if you ask me.”



CHAPTER II

Mr. Polegate’s Sense of Humour

“How time flies!” said Joan Chacewater, in mock despondency. “To-night
I’m in my prime. To-morrow I shall be twenty-one, with all my bright
youth behind me. Five years after that, I shall quite possibly be
married to Michael here, if I’m still alive and he hasn’t died in the
meantime. Then I shall sit o’ nights darning his socks in horn-rimmed
spectacles, and sadly recalling those glad days when I was young and
still happy. It’s dreadful! I feel I want to cry over it. Give me
something to cry into, Michael; I seem to have mislaid my bag.”

Michael Clifton obligingly held out a handkerchief. Joan looked at it
disparagingly.

“Haven’t you anything smaller than that? It discourages me. I’m not
going to cry on a manufacturing scale. It wouldn’t be becoming.”

Una Rainhill laid her cigarette down on the ash-tray beside her.

“If you’re going to be as particular as that, Joan, I think I’d be
content with a gulp or two of emotion or perhaps a lump in the throat.
Cheer up! You’ve one more night before the shadows fall.”

“Ah, there it is!” said Joan, tragically. “You’re young, Una, and you
never had any foresight, anyway. But I can see it all coming. I can
see the fat ankles”—she glanced down at her own slim ones—“and the
artificial silk stockings at three-and-eleven the pair; because
Michael’s business will always be mismanaged, with him at the head of
it. And I’ll have that red nose that comes from indigestion; because
after Michael ends up in bankruptcy, we won’t be able to keep a maid,
and I never could cook anything whatever. And then Michael will grow
fat, and short of breath and bald . . .”

“That’ll be quite enough for the present,” interrupted the outraged
Michael. “I’m not so sure about letting you marry me at all, after
that pleasant little sketch.”

“If you can’t drop those domineering ways of yours, Michael, I shall
withdraw,” Joan warned him, coldly. “You can boss other people as much
as you choose; I rather like to see you doing it. But it doesn’t go
with me, remember. If you show these distressing signs of wanting your
own way, I shall simply have to score you off my list of possibles.
And that would no doubt be painful to both of us—to you, at any rate.”

“Oh, to both of us, to both of us, I’m sure. I wouldn’t dream of
contradicting you, Joan. Where would you be, if the only serious
candidate dropped out? Anything rather than that.”

“Well, it’s a blessing that one man seems to have some sense,” Joan
admitted, turning to the others. “One can’t help liking Michael, if
it’s only for the frank way he acknowledges when he’s in the wrong.
Skilful handling does a lot with the most unpromising material, of
course.”

Cecil leaned over in his chair and peered athwart the greenery which
surrounded the nook in the winter-garden in which they were sitting.

“There’s Foxy wandering round.”

He raised his voice:

“Are you looking for us, Foxy? We’re over here.”

Foxton Polegate’s freckled face, surmounted by a shock of reddish
hair, appeared at the entrance to their recess.

“Been hunting about for you,” he explained as he sat down. “Couldn’t
make out where you’d got to.”

He turned to Joan.

“Dropped across this evening on important business. Fact is, I’ve lost
my invitation-card and the book of words. Didn’t read it carefully
when it came. So thought I’d drop over and hear what’s what.
Programme, I mean, and all that sort of thing, so there’ll be no
hitch.”

Una leaned over and selected a fresh cigarette from the box.

“You’re hopeless, Foxy,” she pronounced. “One of these memory courses
is what you need badly. Why not treat the thing as a practical joke
instead of in earnest? _Then_ you’d have no difficulty. Jokes are the
only things you ever seem to take seriously.”

“Epigrams went completely out before you were born, Una,” Foxy
retorted. “Don’t drag ’em from their graves at this hour of the
century. And don’t interrupt Joan in her instructions to the guest of
the evening. Don’t you see she’s saying ’em over nervously to herself
for fear she forgets ’em?”

“There’s a bit too much of the harassed nursemaid about you, Foxy,
with all your ‘don’ts,’” Joan broke in. “Now take your stylus and
tablets and jot this down carefully, for I won’t repeat it under a
shilling a page. Here’s the programme. Ten p.m.: Arrival of
distinguished guests. (They’re all distinguished, except you, Foxy.)
Brilliant and animated conversation by those who can manage it; the
rest can listen intelligently. (You may try listening, Foxy, if it
isn’t too much of a strain.) The cloak-room, picture-gallery, museum,
and poultry-yard will be thrown open for inspection by the public
absolutely free of charge. It won’t cost you a cent. Bridge-tables
will be provided for the curiosities who don’t dance. Dancing will
begin straightway and will be continued up to 11.45, when the judges
will take their seats. As soon as they are comfortable, the march-past
will start. All guests must present themselves at this without fail,
Foxy. At five minutes to twelve the identity of the prize-winners will
be disclosed. When midnight strikes, all guests will remove their
masks, even at the cost of shocking the company in some cases. Dancing
will then be resumed and will continue into the dewy dawn. And that’s
how it will take place according to plan.”

“There’s just one point,” said Foxy, hesitatingly. “Are the prizes
portable things, or shall I have to hire a van to take mine away with
me?”

“I shouldn’t worry a bit about that, Foxy,” said Una, comfortingly.
“We’ve decided to keep the prizes in the family, you see. Joan gets
one, because it will be her birthday. I get the other for the best
female costume. Cecil, Maurice, and Michael are going to toss odd-man
for the two men’s prizes. So you can come as a Teddy Bear without
pockets if you like. It won’t be of any consequence. You’ll have
nothing to carry away.”

“Can’t say fairer than that,” Foxy admitted. “Always liked that plain,
straightforward way of doing things myself.”

A recollection of his talk with Sir Clinton passed across Cecil
Chacewater’s mind, and without reflection he communicated it to the
others:

“By the way, Sir Clinton seemed a trifle worried over this affair. He
pointed out to me that some scallywag might creep in amongst the
guests and play Old Harry in the museum if he got the chance.”

Just at this moment, Maurice Chacewater passed along the alley in the
winter-garden from which the nook opened.

“Maurice!” Joan called to her brother. “Come here for a moment,
please.”

Maurice turned back and entered the recess. He seemed tired; and there
was a certain hesitancy in his manner as though he were not quite sure
of himself. His sister made a gesture inviting him to sit down, but he
appeared disinclined to stay.

“What’s the trouble?” he asked, with a weary air.

“Cecil’s been suggesting that it’s hardly safe to leave the
collections open to-morrow night, in case a stranger got in with a
mask on. Hadn’t we better have some one to stay in the museum and look
after them?”

“Cecil needn’t worry his head,” Maurice returned, ignoring his
brother. “I’m putting one of the keepers on to watch the museum.”

He turned on his heel and went off along the corridor. Foxy gazed
after him with a peculiar expression on his face.

“Maurice looks a bit done-up, doesn’t he?” he finally said, turning
back towards the group about him. “He hasn’t been quite all right for
a while. Seems almost as if he expected a thunderbolt to strike him
any minute, doesn’t he? A bit white about the gills and holding
himself in all the time.”

Before any one could reply to this, Joan rose and beckoned to Michael.

“Come along, Michael. I’ll play you a hundred up, if you like.
There’ll be no one in the billiard-room.”

Michael Clifton rose eagerly from his chair and followed her out. Foxy
looked after them.

“As an old friend of the family, merely wanting to know, _are_ those
two engaged or not? They go on as if they were and as if they weren’t.
It’s most confusing to plain fellows like me.”

“I doubt if they know themselves,” said Una, “so I’d advise you not to
waste too much brain-matter over it, Foxy. What do boys of your age
know about such things?”

“Not much, not much, I admit. Cupid seems to pass me by on his rounds.
Perhaps it’s the red hair. Or maybe the freckles. Or because I’m not
the strong, talkative sort like Michael. Or just Fate, or something.”

“I expect it’s just Something, as you say,” Una confirmed in a
sympathetic tone. “That seems, somehow, to explain everything, doesn’t
it?”

“As it were, yes,” retorted Foxy. “But don’t let the fact that you’ve
ensnared Cecil—poor chap—lead you into putting on expert airs with me.
Betrays inexperience at once, that. Only the very young do it.”

His face lighted up.

“I’ve just thought of something. What a joke! Suppose we took the
Chief Constable’s tip and engineered a sham robbery to-morrow night?
Priceless, what? Carry it through in real good style. Make Maurice sit
up for a day or two, eh? Do his liver good if he’d something to worry
about.”

Cecil’s face showed indecision.

“I shouldn’t mind giving Maurice a twinge or two just to teach him
manners,” he confessed. “But I don’t see much in the notion as it
stands, Foxy. Maurice is posting a keeper in the museum, you know; and
that complicates things a bit. The keeper would spot any of us
tampering with things. He knows us all as well as his own brother.”

“Not in fancy dress, with a mask on, dear boy. Don’t forget that part
of it.

    ‘Fancy me in fancy dress,
    Fancy me as Good Queen Bess!’”

he hummed softly. “Only I don’t think I’ll come as Good Queen Bess,
after all.”

Cecil knitted his brows slightly and seemed to be considering Foxy’s
idea.

“I wouldn’t mind giving Maurice a start,” he admitted
half-reluctantly. “And your notion might be good enough if one could
work it out properly. Question is, can you? Suppose you suddenly make
a grab for some of the stuff. The keeper’ll be down on you like a
shot. He’ll yell for help; and you’ll be pinched for a cert. before
you could get away. There doesn’t seem to be anything in it, Foxy.”

“Hold on for a minute. I’ll see my way through it.”

Foxy took a cigarette, lighted it, and seemed to cogitate deeply over
the first few puffs.

“I’ve got it!” he announced. “It’s dead easy. Suppose one of us grabs
the keeper while the other helps himself to the till? We could easily
knock out the keeper between us and get off all right without an alarm
being raised.”

Cecil shook his head.

“No, I draw the line at using a sand-bag or a knuckle-duster on our
own keeper. That’s barred, Foxy. Think again.”

“There’s aye a way,” Foxy assured him sententiously. “Give me another
jiffy or two. This is how it goes. We mustn’t knock out the keeper. We
mustn’t be recognized. We’ve got to get away scot-free, or the joke
would be on us. These the conditions?”

Cecil nodded.

“This is where pure genius comes in,” Foxy announced with pride. “How
does one recognize any one? By looking at ’em. So if the keeper can’t
look at us, he won’t recognize us. That’s as sound as Euclid, if not
sounder.”

“Well?” asked Una, joining in the conversation.

“Well, he won’t recognize us if the place is dark, then,” explained
Foxy, triumphantly. “All we have to do is to get the light in the room
switched off, and the thing’s as good as done.”

“That seems to hit the mark,” Cecil agreed. “But that makes it a
three-handed job, you know: one to grab the keeper; one to snaffle the
stuff; and one to pull out the fuse of the museum light from the
fuse-box. Where’s our third man?”

Una leaned forward eagerly.

“I’ll do that part for you! I’d like to make Maurice sit up. He hasn’t
been very nice to me lately; and I want to pay him out just a little.”

“Nonsense, Una,” Cecil interrupted. “You can’t be mixed up in a joke
of this sort. There’s almost bound to be a row after it. It doesn’t
matter in my case; Maurice has his knife into me anyway, you know. But
there’s no need for you to be getting your fingers nipped.”

Una brushed the suggestion aside.

“What can Maurice do to me even if he does find out? I’ve nothing to
do with him. And, besides, how is he going to find out anything about
it? I suppose you’ll just keep the things for a day or two and then
return them by some way that he can’t trace. He’ll never know who did
it, unless we let it out ourselves. And we mustn’t let it out, of
course.”

Foxy nodded his agreement. Cecil was longer in his consideration; but
at last he seemed to fall in with the arrangement.

“Well, so long as Una’s name isn’t mixed up in it, Foxy, I’m your man.
It’s a silly caper; but I’m not above going into it for the sport of
vexing my good brother.”

“Right!” said Foxy, with relief. “Now the next article: What’s the
best thing to go for? It must be portable, of course.”

Cecil pondered for a moment; then, as a thought struck him, he
laughed.

“Here’s the game. It may be news to you, Foxy, but my good brother is
taking steps to sell off our collections.”

Foxy was quite plainly staggered by this news.

“All the stuff your father got together? Surely not! Well, that’s the
limit!”

“Quite,” confirmed Cecil. “I’d prevent it if I could; but he’s got the
whip-hand, and that’s all there is to it.”

Foxy seemed still slightly incredulous.

“Why, your Governor loved that stuff as it were a child! And Maurice
doesn’t need the money he’ll get for it. It’s . . . it’s shameful! My
word! If I were in your shoes, Cecil, I believe I’d really steal the
stuff instead of only pretending to grab it.”

“I’m sorely tempted,” said Cecil, half-grimly. “Now here’s the point.
It seems Maurice has got into touch with Kessock, the Yank
millionaire. Kessock wants to buy the Medusa Medallions—the very thing
my father set most store by in the whole lot. Kessock’s sent over an
agent of his—this fellow Foss who’s staying here just now—to settle up
the business, see to the genuineness of the things, and so forth. I’ve
nothing against Foss. He’s only doing his job and he seems all right.
I don’t like some of his American manners; but that’s neither here nor
there. The point is, the deal’s just going to be closed. Now if we
lift these medallions, won’t Maurice look an extra-sized ass?”

“Absoluto!” said Foxy. “I see what you’re after. We lift ’em. Foss
wants ’em at once. He can’t get ’em. P’raps the deal’s off—for the
time at least. And Maurice looks a prize ape.”

“Yes,” Cecil snapped, angrily. “That’ll perhaps teach him a lesson.”

Una Rainhill had been thinking while this last part of the
conversation had been going on.

“There’s one thing you haven’t provided against, Foxy,” she pointed
out. “Suppose you manage everything as you’ve arranged. Even if you
get clear away from the museum, there’s almost certain to be some one
in the passage outside who’ll see you rush out. And then the game
would be up. It’s not enough to dowse the light in the museum. You’ll
need to put all the house lights out as well.”

“That’s sound,” Foxy agreed at once. “That means that you’ll need to
pull out the main switch instead of just the fuse of the museum. It’s
an even easier job, with no chance of a mistake in it. And what a
spree it’ll be. The whole shop will be buzzing like an overturned
hive! It’ll be great sport. And, of course, there’ll be such a wild
confusion before they get the lights on again, that we’ll come out of
it absolutely O.K. All we have to do is to saunter quietly out of the
museum and help to restore order among the rabble in the dark. By the
time the lights go on again, we’ll be anywhere it suits us to be.
That’s a master-stroke of yours, Una. Couldn’t be bettered.”

Cecil glanced at his wrist-watch.

“Time’s getting on, Foxy. We’ve sketched the general idea, but we must
get this thing down to dots now. Everything will depend on
synchronizing things exactly. We can’t afford to leave affairs to the
last moment; for we mustn’t be seen together, you know, to-morrow
night.”

Foxy nodded assent and pulled out a notebook.

“Here it is, then,” he declared. “I’ll make three copies—one for each
of us—and we can burn ’em once we’ve memorized ’em later on. Now,
first of all, we can’t start our game too early. That’d be a mistake.
Let ’em all get well mixed up in dancing and so forth, before we begin
operations.”

Cecil and Una assented to this at once.

“Midnight’s the limit at the other end,” Foxy pointed out. “Can’t
afford to wait for the unmasking, for then the keeper would know us
and remember we’d been in the museum when the thing happened.”

His fellow-conspirators made no objection.

“In between those limits, I think this would be about right,” Foxy
proposed. “First of all, we set our three watches to the same time.
Better do it now, for fear of forgetting.”

When this had been done, he continued:

“At 11.40 Una goes to the main switch. You’ll have to show her where
it is, Cecil, either to-night or to-morrow morning. At 11.40, also,
Cecil and I wander independently into the museum. I remember quite
well where the medallions are kept.”

“Wait a moment,” interrupted Cecil. “Just remember that the three real
medallions and your three electrotypes are lying side by side in the
glass case. The real medallions are in the top row; your electros are
the bottom row.”

Foxy made a note of this and then went on:

“Your business, Cecil, will be to mark down the keeper. Get so near
him that you can jump on him for certain the very instant the lights
go out. Make sure you can get his hands or his wrists at the first
grab. You mustn’t fumble it or you’ll shipwreck the whole caboodle.”

“I’ll manage it all right,” Cecil assured him.

“In the meantime I’ll be stooping over the medallion case, looking at
the stuff, with something in my hand to break the glass. I’ll have a
thick glove, so as not to get cut with the edges when I put my hand
in.”

“That’s sound,” said Cecil, “I hadn’t thought of the splinters.”

“Blood would give us away at once,” Foxy pointed out. “Now comes the
real business. At a quarter to twelve precisely Una pulls out the
switch. As soon as the light goes, Cecil jumps on the keeper while I
smash the glass of the case and grab the top row of the medallions.
After that, we both cut for the door and mingle with the mob. And
remember, not a word said during the whole affair. Our voices would
give us away to the keeper.”

He scribbled two extra copies of his time-table and handed one of
these to each of the other conspirators.

“Now, for my sake, don’t botch this business,” he added. “I’ve played
a joke or two in my time, but this is the best I’ve ever done, and I
don’t want it spoiled by inattention to details. It’ll be worth all
the trouble to see Maurice’s face when he finds what’s happened.”



CHAPTER III

The Theft at the Masked Ball

“I’m thankful I took my wings off,” said Ariel, leaning back in her
chair with a soft sigh of satisfaction. “You’ve no notion how much you
long to sit down when you know you daren’t do it for fear of crushing
the frames of these things. It’s not tiredness; it’s simply
tantalization.”

She turned her eyes inquisitively on the bearded figure of her
partner.

“I wonder who you’re supposed to be?” she mused. “You ought to have a
ticket, with a costume like that. I can’t guess who you imagine you
are—or who you really are, for that matter.”

Her companion showed no desire to enlighten her on the last point.

“‘My quaint Ariel, hark in thine ear,’” he quoted, but she failed to
recognize the tones of his voice.

“Oh, now I see! We did ‘The Tempest’ one year at school. So you’re
Prospero, are you? Well, don’t let’s begin by any misunderstandings.
If you think you’re entitled to act your part by ordering me about,
you’re far mistaken. My trade union positively refuses to permit any
overtime.”

“I’ve left my book and staff in the cloak-room,” Prospero confessed,
laughingly, “otherwise, malignant spirit . . .”

“‘That’s my noble master!’” quoted Ariel, ironically. “Prospero was a
cross old thing. I suppose you couldn’t even throw in a bit of
conjuring to keep up appearances? It’s almost expected of you.”

Prospero looked cautiously round the winter-garden in which they were
sitting.

“Not much field here for my illimitable powers,” he grumbled
disparagingly, “unless you’d like me to turn Falstaff over there into
a white rabbit. And that would startle his partner somewhat, I’m
afraid, so we’d better not risk it.”

He pondered for a moment.

“I hate to disappoint you, Ariel. What about a turn at divination?
Would it amuse you if I told your fortune, revealed the secrets of
your soul, and what not? This is how I do it; it’s called Botanomancy,
if you desire to pursue your studies on a more convenient occasion.”

He stretched up his hand and plucked a leaf from the tropical plant
above his head. Ariel watched him mischievously from behind her mask.

“Well, Prospero, get along with it, will you? The next dance will be
starting sooner than immediately.”

Prospero pretended to study the leaf minutely before continuing.

“I see a girl who likes to play at having her own way . . . and isn’t
too scrupulous in her methods of getting it. She is very happy . . .
happier, perhaps, than she has ever been before. . . . I see two
Thresholds, one of which she has just crossed, the other which she
will cross after this next dance, I think. Yes, that is correct.
There’s some influence in the background. . . .”

He broke off and regarded Ariel blandly.

“So much for the signs. Now for the interpretation. You are obviously
in the very early twenties; so I infer that the Threshold you are
about to cross lies between your twentieth and twenty-first birthday.
Putting that along with the character which the leaf revealed . . .
Why, Ariel, you must be Miss Joan Chacewater, and you’ve just got
engaged!”

“You seem to know me all right, Prospero,” Joan admitted. “But how
about the engagement? It’s too dim in here for you to have seen my
ring; and besides, I’ve had my hand in the folds of my dress ever
since I sat down.”

“Except for one moment when you settled the band round your hair,”
Prospero pointed out. “The ring you’re wearing is more than a shade
too large for your finger—obviously it’s so new that you haven’t had
time to get it altered to fit, yet.”

“You seem to notice things,” Joan admitted. “I wonder who you are.”

Prospero brushed her inquiry aside.

“A little parlour conjuring to finish up the part in due form?” he
suggested. “It’s almost time for our dance. Look!”

He held out an empty hand for Joan’s inspection, then made a slight
snatch in the air as if seizing something in flight. When he extended
his hand again, a small diamond star glittered in the palm.

“Take it, Joan,” said Sir Clinton in his natural voice. “I meant to
send it to you to-morrow; but at the last moment I thought I might as
well bring it with me and have the pleasure of giving it to you
myself. It’s your birthday present. I’m an old enough friend to give
you diamonds on a special occasion like this.”

“You took me in completely,” Joan admitted, after she had thanked him.
“I couldn’t make out who you were; and I thought you were the limit in
insolence when you began talking about my private affairs.”

“It’s Michael Clifton, of course?” Sir Clinton asked.

“Why ‘of course’? One would think he’d been my last chance, by the way
you put it. This living on a magic island has ruined your manners, my
good Prospero.”

“Well, he won’t let you down, Joan. You—shall I say, even you, to be
tactful—couldn’t have done better in the raffle.”

Before Joan could reply, a girl in Egyptian costume came past their
chairs. Joan stopped her with a gesture.

“Pin this pretty thing in the front of my band, please, Cleopatra. Be
sure you get it in the right place.”

She held out the diamond star. Cleopatra took it without comment and
fastened it in position hastily.

“Sit down,” Joan invited, “your next partner will find you here when
he comes. Tell us about Cæsar and Antony and all the rest of your
disreputable past. Make it exciting.”

Cleopatra shook her head.

“Sorry I can’t stop just now. Neither Julius nor Antony put in an
appearance to-night, so I’m spending my arts on a mere centurion. He’s
a stickler for punctuality—being a Roman soldier.”

She glanced at her wrist-watch.

“I must fly at once. O reservoir! as we say in Egypt, you know.”

With a nod of farewell, she hastened along the alley and out of the
winter-garden.

“She seems a trifle nervous about something,” Sir Clinton commented,
indifferently.

Joan smoothed down her filmy tunic.

“Isn’t it time we moved?” she asked. “I see Falstaff’s gone away, so
you can’t turn him into a white rabbit now; and there doesn’t seem to
be anything else you could enchant just at present. The orchestra will
be starting in a moment, anyhow.”

She rose as she spoke. Sir Clinton followed her example, and they made
their way out of the winter-garden.

“What costume is Michael Clifton wearing to-night?” asked Sir Clinton
as the orchestra played the opening bars of the dance. “I ought to
congratulate him; and it’s easier to pick him up at a distance if I
know how he’s dressed.”

“Look for something in eighteenth-century clothes and a large wig,
then,” Joan directed. “He says he’s Macheath out of the ‘Beggar’s
Opera.’ I suppose he’s quite as like that as anything else. You’ll
perhaps recognize him best by a large artificial mole at the left
corner of his mouth. I observed it particularly myself.”

She noticed that her partner seemed more on the alert than the
occasion required.

“What are you worried about?” she demanded. “You seem to be listening
for something; and you can’t hear anything, you know, even if you
tried, because of the orchestra.”

Sir Clinton shook off his air of preoccupation.

“The fact is, Joan, I’ve been worried all evening. I’m really afraid
of something happening to-night. I don’t much like this mask business
with all that stuff in the collections. I’ve a feeling in my bones
that there might be trouble.”

Joan laughed at his gloomy premonitions.

“You won’t be kept on the rack much longer, that’s one good thing.
There’s just this dance, then the march-past for judging the costumes,
and then it will be midnight when everybody must unmask. So you’ll
have to make the best of your fears in the next half-hour. After that
there’ll be no excuse for them.”

“Meanwhile, on with the dance, eh?” said Sir Clinton. “I see it’s no
use trying to give you a nightmare. You’re too poor a subject to repay
the labour and trouble. Besides, this music’s terribly straining on
the vocal cords if one tries to compete with it.”

As he spoke, however, the orchestra reached a diminuendo in the score
and sank to comparative quietness. Joan looked here and there about
the room as they danced and at last detected the figure for which she
was searching.

“That’s Michael over there,” she pointed out, “the one dancing with
the girl dressed as . . .”

Across the sound of the music there cut the sharp report of a
small-calibre pistol fired in some adjacent room. On the heels
of it came the crash and tinkle of falling glass, and, almost
simultaneously, a cry for help in a man’s voice.

Sir Clinton let Joan’s hand go and turned to the door; but before he
could take a step, the lights above them vanished and the room was
plunged in darkness. Joan felt a hand come out and grip her arm.

“That you, Joan?”

“Yes.”

“They’ve taken out the main switch,” Sir Clinton said hurriedly. “Get
hold of some man at once and show him where it is. We want the lights
as quick as possible. I can trust you not to lose your head. Take a
man with you for fear of trouble. We don’t know what’s happening.”

“Very well,” Joan assured him.

“Hurry!” Sir Clinton urged.

His hand dropped from her arm as he moved invisibly away towards the
door. In the darkness around her she could hear movements and startled
exclamations. The orchestra, after mechanically playing a couple of
bars, had fallen to silence. Some one blundered into her and passed on
before she could put out her hand.

“Well, at least I know where the door is,” she assured herself; and
she began to move towards it.

Meanwhile the cries for help continued to come from the museum. Then,
abruptly, they were hushed; and she shuddered as she thought of what
that cessation might mean. She moved forward and came to what seemed
an unobstructed space on the floor, over which she was able to advance
freely.

Her whole senses were concentrated on reaching the exit; but her mind
appeared to work independently of her own volition and to conjure up
the possibilities behind this series of events. Sir Clinton had
evidently expected some criminal attempt that night; and he had
assumed that the museum would be the objective. But suppose he were
wrong. Perhaps the affair in the museum was only a blind to draw
towards it all the men outside the ball-room. Then, when they were
disposed of, there might come an incursion here. Most of the women had
taken advantage of their fancy dress to deck themselves out with
jewellery, and a few armed men could easily reap a small fortune in a
minute or two. Despite the soundness of her nerves, she began to feel
anxious, and to conjure up still more appalling pictures.

Suddenly her eyes were dazzled by a flash of light as a man beside her
struck a match. Almost at the same moment she felt a hand on her
shoulder and she was pulled backwards so brusquely that she almost
lost her balance and slipped.

“Put out that match, you fool!” said Michael’s voice. “Do you want to
have these girls’ dresses in a blaze?”

The flare of the match had revealed a circle of startled faces. The
room was filled with excited voices and a sound of confused movements.
Over at the orchestra a music-stand fell with a clash of metal. Then,
close beside her in the darkness, Joan heard a girl’s voice repeating
monotonously in tones of acute fear: “What does it mean? Oh, what does
it mean?”

“Much good _that_ does any one,” Joan muttered, contemptuously. Then,
aloud, she called: “Michael!”

Before he could reply, there came a sharp exclamation in a man’s
voice:

“Stand back, there! My partner’s fainted.”

The possibilities involved in a panic suddenly became all too clear in
Joan’s mind. If half a dozen people lost their heads, the girl might
be badly hurt.

Michael’s voice was lifted again, in a tone that would have carried
through a storm at sea:

“Everybody stand fast! You’ll be trampling the girl underfoot if you
don’t take care. Stand still, confound you! Pull the blinds up and
throw back the curtains. It’s a moonlight night.”

There was a rustling as those nearest the windows set about the
execution of his orders. Light suddenly appeared, revealing the
strained faces and uneasy attitudes of the company. Joan turned to
Michael.

“Come with me and put in the switch, Michael. Sir Clinton’s gone to
the museum. We must get the lights on quick.”

Michael, with a word to his partner, followed his fiancée towards the
door. A thought seemed to strike him just as he was leaving the room:

“Wait here, everybody, till we get the lights on again. You’ll just
run risks by moving about in the dark outside. It’s nothing. Probably
only a fuse blown.”

“Now then, Joan, where’s that switch?” he added as they passed out of
the door.

It was pitch-dark in the rest of the house; but Joan knew her way and
was able to grope along the corridors without much difficulty. As they
came near the switch-box, the lights flashed up again. One of the
servants appeared round a corner.

“Some one had pulled out the switch, sir,” he explained. “It took me
some time to make my way to it and put it in again.”

“Stout fellow!” said Michael, approvingly.

At that moment, a voice shouted above the confused noises of the
house:

“Come on, you fellows! He’s got away. Lend hand to chase him.”

And a sound of running steps filled the hall, as the male guests
poured out in answer to the summons.

“You don’t need me any longer, Joan?” Michael questioned. “Right! Then
I’m off to lend a hand.”

He ran to join the rest.

Left alone, Joan retraced her steps to the ball-room; but instead of
re-entering it, she passed on in the direction of the museum, whither
a number of the guests were making their way also.

“I hope nobody’s got badly hurt,” she thought to herself as she
hurried along. “I do wish I’d taken the hint and not asked to have
that collection thrown open to-night.”

Much to her relief, she found Sir Clinton sitting on a chair beside
the museum door. In the doorway stood the keeper, looking none the
worse and busying himself with fending off the more inquisitive among
the guests who wished to enter the room. Joan noticed that the museum
itself was in darkness though the lights were burning in the rest of
the house.

“You’re not hurt, are you, Sir Clinton?” she asked as she came up to
him.

“Nothing to speak of. The fellow kicked me on the ankle as he came
out. I’m temporarily lamed, that’s all. Nothing to worry about, I
think.”

He rubbed his ankle as he spoke.

“Are you all right, Mold?” Joan inquired.

The keeper reassured her.

“No harm done, Miss Joan. They didn’t hurt me. But I’m sorry, miss, I
didn’t manage to get hold of them. They were on me before I could do
anything, me being so taken aback by the lights going out.”

“What’s happened?” Joan questioned Sir Clinton. “Has anything been
stolen?”

“We don’t know yet what’s gone,” he replied, answering her last
question first. “The bulk of the lamp’s smashed in there”—he nodded
towards the museum—“and until they bring a fresh one, we can’t find
out what damage has been done. As to what happened, it seems rather
confused at present; but I expect we shall get it cleared up
eventually. There seems to have been a gang at work; and I’m afraid
some things may be missing when we begin to look over the collection.”

“I wish I’d taken your hint,” Joan admitted, frankly. “It’s partly my
blame, I feel, for neglecting your advice. I was silly to laugh at you
when you spoke about it.”

“I shouldn’t worry about it, if I were you, Joan,” Sir Clinton
reassured her. “It was really only one chance in a million that
anything of the sort would happen to-night. Besides, if we manage to
nail this fellow that they’re all after, we may be able to get some
clue to his confederates. Quite evidently there was a gang at work,
and he may be induced to split on his friends if we can lay hands on
him; and then we’ll get the stuff back again without much trouble, I
hope.”

He glanced at her, as though to see the effect of his words; then, as
his eyes caught her mask, he seemed struck by another idea.

“That reminds me,” he said, “we must get these masks off. Send some
one round at once, please, Joan, to order every one to unmask now. And
have all the outer doors shut, too. It’s a futile precaution, I’m
afraid; because any one could slip out during the confusion when there
was no light: but we may as well do what we can even at this stage.”

He removed his own mask as he spoke, and pulled away the false beard
which he had worn as Prospero. Joan loosened her mask and went off to
give the necessary orders. In a few moments she returned.

“Now tell me what did happen,” she demanded.

“There’s no one killed, or even hurt,” Sir Clinton assured her. “This
ankle of mine’s the only casualty, so far as I know; and I expect I’ll
be able to limp about quite comfortably by to-morrow.”

“I’m thankful it’s no worse,” said Joan, with relief.

“All I know about the business comes from Mold, here,” Sir Clinton
went on. “It seems he was patrolling the museum at the time the thing
happened, under your brother’s orders. Perhaps half a dozen
people—under a dozen, he says, at any rate—were in the place then.
Some of them were examining the cases in the bays; some of them were
looking at the things in the big centre case. Mold doesn’t remember
what costumes they were wearing. I don’t blame him. People had been
passing in and out all through the evening; and there was no reason
why he should take particular note of the guests at that special
moment.”

Sir Clinton glanced up at the keeper, who was looking rather ashamed
at his inability to furnish better information.

“Don’t you worry, Mold. I doubt if I’d have had any more to tell,
myself, if I’d been there. One can’t be expected to remember
everything.”

He turned back to Joan.

“The next thing that happened was a pistol-shot, and the light went
out. Some light filtered in from the door of the room, for the lamps
in the hall here were still blazing; but before Mold could do
anything, some one gripped him from behind and got his wrists twisted
behind his back. In the struggle Mold was swung round, so that he
couldn’t see the central case even in what light there was. Then the
lights outside were switched off and he heard a smashing of glass.
There was a bit of a struggle, apparently; and then all at once he
felt himself let loose. As soon as he got free, he lit a match and
posted himself at the door to prevent any one getting away; and he
stayed there until the lights went on again. Then he made all his
prisoners unmask and those whom he didn’t recognize himself he kept
there until some one he knew came to identify them. They’re all people
you know quite well, Joan. More than half of them were girls, who seem
rather unlikely people to go in for robbery with violence, to put it
mildly. Mold made a list of them, if we happen to need it. But I don’t
think we’re likely to find the criminal amongst them. This affair was
too well planned for that. The real gang have got clean away, I’m
pretty sure.”

“And what about your ankle?” demanded Joan.

“Oh, that? I happened to arrive at the door fairly quickly after the
lights went out. Just as I got to it, a fellow came dashing out; and I
made a grab at him as well as I could in the dark. But one can’t see
what one’s doing; and I didn’t get a decent grip on him as he charged
out on top of me. He landed me a fairly effective kick—right on the
ankle-bone, by bad luck—and then, before I could get my hands on him
properly he tore himself clear and was off down the hall towards the
front door. I hobbled after him as best I could; and there he was—a
fellow dressed in Pierrot costume—running quite leisurely over the
gravel sweep and making for the woods. I couldn’t go after him; but he
was quite clear in the moonlight and he’d a long way to go before
getting into cover; so I raised a hue and cry at once, and quite a
crowd of stout fellows are after him. He’ll have to run a bit faster
than he was doing, if he expects to get off. These pine-woods have no
undergrowth to speak of; and he’ll find it difficult to conceal
himself in a hurry.”

As Sir Clinton ended his narrative a servant came hurrying up the
hall, bringing a tall pair of steps with him.

“Is that the new lamp?” Sir Clinton demanded. “All right. Light a
match or two, Mold, to let him see where to put the steps. And don’t
tramp about too much while you’re fixing them up, please. I want to
see things undisturbed as far as possible.”



CHAPTER IV

The Chase in the Woods

In earlier days, Michael Clifton had been reckoned among the more
creditable runners in the School Mile; and he had never allowed
himself to fall out of training. Thus as he joined the throng of
would-be pursuers emerging from the house, he felt a certain
confidence that the fugitive would at any rate have to put his best
foot foremost if he was to avoid being run down. Before he had covered
twenty yards, however, Michael found himself handicapped by his
costume. The full-bottomed wig dropped off almost immediately, and the
shoes were not so troublesome as he had feared; but the sleeves of his
coat interfered with his movements, and the long skirts hampered his
legs.

“I wonder if these coves in the eighteenth century ever ran a step,”
he grumbled. “If they did it in this kit, they must have been wonders.
I must get rid of the truck.”

He pulled up and stripped off the full-skirted coat; then, as an
after-thought, he removed the long waistcoat as well. While doing
this, he glanced ahead to see how the chase was progressing. The light
of the full moon, now at its highest in the cloudless heavens, lit up
the whole landscape before him almost as clearly as daylight. Far
ahead, he could see the white figure of the escaping thief as it
ascended the long, gentle slope towards the pine-woods.

“I wonder what tempted the beggar to choose that particular costume on
a night like this,” Michael speculated. “It’s the most conspicuous
affair he could have put on. Well, all the better for us.”

The quarry had evidently secured a fair start, for the nearest group
of pursuers was still a considerable distance behind him. The hunters
were strung out in an irregular file, knotted here and there with
groups of three or four runners; and the line extended back almost to
Michael’s position. Behind him, he could hear fresh reinforcements
emerging from the house, shouting as they came.

“They’d better save their breath,” Michael commented critically to
himself. “That long rise’ll take it out of a good many of them.”

He settled down to his favourite stride; and very soon began to
overtake the laggards at the tail of the chase. In front of him
he saw a Cardinal Richelieu with kilted cassock; but the Cardinal
found his costume too much for him and pulled out of the race as
Michael passed him. Shortly after, Michael drew level with an early
nineteenth-century dandy and for a few seconds they raced neck and
neck. The dandy, however, was unable to stay the pace.

“It’s these damned Johnny Walker boots,” he gasped, as he fell behind.

Michael, running comfortably, began to take a faint amusement in the
misfortunes of his colleagues. He could not help smiling as he passed
a Minotaur, sitting beside the track and making furious efforts to
disentangle himself from his pasteboard bull’s head which seemed to
have become clamped in position. But as he found two more of the
hunters by the wayside, a fresh point of view occurred to him.

“If they’re going to drop out at this rate, there won’t be many of us
left at the finish to tackle the beggar; and he’s armed. We’ll need
all the men we can scrape up, if we’re to make sure of him.”

Glancing ahead again, he was relieved to see that he had gained a fair
amount of ground on the fugitive; and now he began to pass runner
after runner, as the rising slope told on the weaker pursuers. He
reached the group at the head of the chase just as the escaping
burglar dashed into the shadow of the woods a hundred yards in
advance.

“He’ll dodge us now, if he can,” Michael warned his companions, who
evidently were unacquainted with the ground. “Keep your eyes on him at
any cost.”

But as they entered the pine arcades, Michael found that he was
mistaken. The quarry maintained his lead; but he made no effort to
leave the beaten track. Ahead of them they could see his white-clad
figure dappled with light and darkness as he sped up the broad
pathway.

Suddenly, Michael remembered what lay beyond the pine-wood. Without
raising his voice, for fear the runner in front should hear him, he
explained the situation.

“He doesn’t know what he’s running into. There’s a big quarry up
there, with barbed wire fences on each side. If we can keep him
straight for it, we’ll have him pinned.”

On went the fugitive, still maintaining his lead and glancing over his
shoulder from time to time, as though he were gauging the distance
which separated him from his closest pursuers.

“The beggar can run, certainly,” Michael admitted to himself. “But
running isn’t going to help him much in a minute or two. We have him
on toast.”

In a few moments the moon shone bright through the trees ahead. As
they reached the edge of the wood, the white figure in front of them
showed up clearly as it sprinted across the strip of open ground,
straight for the spinney which bounded the quarry cliff. With a
gesture, Michael called his motley group to a halt.

“Wait a minute,” he ordered. “You, Mephistopheles, get off to the left
there, outside the spinney. Go on until you strike barbed wire. Take
this Prehistoric Man—oh, it’s you, is it, Frankie? Well, both of you
get down there and act as stoppers, so that he can’t sneak off along
the fence. Oliver Cromwell and you in the funny coat! You’re to do the
same over yonder on the right. Put some hurry into it, now! And don’t
move in towards him till you get the word. The rest of you, extend a
bit along the near edge of the spinney. Not too close; give yourselves
a chance of spotting him if he breaks cover. And don’t yell unless you
actually see him. We’ve got him shut in now, and we can afford to wait
for reinforcements. Here they come!”

Two panting runners breasted the hill as he spoke. At this moment
there came from beyond the spinney the sound of a splash. Michael was
taken aback.

“The beggar can’t have dived over, surely. It’s full of rocks down
below. We’ll have to hurry up. He might get away, after all, if he’s
extra lucky.”

A fresh group of pursuers gave him the reinforcements he needed; and
he fed them into his cordon at its weak points.

“Pass the word for the whole line to close in!”

The cordon began to contract around the spinney, the wide gaps in it
closing up as it advanced.

“The beggar’s probably got a pistol; look out for yourselves among the
trees,” Michael cautioned them as they reached the boundary of the
plantation. “Don’t hurry. And keep in touch, whatever you do.”

He himself was at the centre of the line and was the first to enter
the tiny wood. The advance was slow; for here there was some
undergrowth which might offer a hiding-place to the fugitive; and this
was carefully scrutinized, clump by clump, before the line moved
forward as a whole. Michael meant to make certain of capturing the
burglar; and he could afford now to go about the matter deliberately.
Fresh reinforcements in twos and threes were still streaming in from
the pine-wood.

It took only a few minutes, however, to draw his screen through the
spinney; for the belt of trees was a narrow one. Every instant he
expected to hear a shout indicating that the quarry had been run to
earth; but none came. His line emerged intact from the trees, forming
an arc of which the cliff-face was the chord; and as his men came out
into the moonlight Michael had to admit to himself that no one could
well have crept through any gap in the cordon.

“He must be out here, hiding among these seats,” he shouted. “Don’t
break your line any more than you can help. Advance to that balustrade
in front. Rush him, if he shows up.”

Now that he was sure of his quarry, Michael at last had leisure to
note the tincture of the bizarre in the scene before him. The
high-riding moon whitened the terrace and touched with glamour the
motley costumes of the hunters preparing for their final swoop. Here
Robin Hood and a hatless Flying Dutchman were stooping to peer below
one of the marble seats. Farther along the line Lohengrin and a
Milkman discussed something eagerly in whispers. On the left the
Prehistoric Man loomed up like a Troglodyte emerging from his cave;
while beyond him Mephistopheles leaned upon the railing, scanning the
water below. From the inky shadow of the spinney Felix the Cat stole
softly out to join the cordon.

“A weird-looking gang we are,” Michael commented to himself as he
gazed about him.

Only a few steps separated the hunters from the clear floor of the
terrace. In a second or two at most, the man they were chasing must
break cover and make a dash for liberty or else tamely surrender.
Slowly the line crept forward.

“We’ve got him now!” a voice cried, exultantly.

But the living net swept on past the marble tier without catching
anything in its meshes. Between it and the balustrade was nothing but
the untenanted paving of the terrace.

“He’s got away!” ejaculated some one in tones of complete amazement.
“Well, I’m damned if I see how he managed it.”

The chain broke up into individuals, who hurried hither and thither on
the esplanade searching even in the most unlikely spots for the
missing fugitive. All at once Michael’s eye caught something which had
been concealed in the shadows thrown by the moon.

“Here’s a rope, you fellows! He’s gone down the face of the cliff.
Swum the lake, probably.”

Mephistopheles dissented in a languid drawl.

“Not he, Clifton. I’ve had my eye on the water ever since I got up to
the barbed wire. You could spot the faintest ripple in this moonshine.
He didn’t get off that way.”

“Sure of that?” demanded Michael.

“Dead sure. I watched specially.”

Michael hesitated for a moment or two, considering the situation. Then
his face cleared.

“I see it! I remember there’s a cave right below here, in the
cliff-face. He’s gone to ground there. Half of you get through the
barbed wire on the right; the rest take the left side. Line up on the
banks when you get down to the water. He may swim for it yet if we
don’t hurry.”

They raced off to carry out his instructions, while Michael pulled up
the rope and flung it on the terrace.

“That cuts off his escape in this direction,” he said to himself. “Now
we can dig him out at leisure.”

Without hurrying, he made his way down to the water.

“There used to be a raft of sorts here,” he explained. “If we can rout
it out, we’ll be able to ferry across to the cave-mouth without much
bother. I doubt if he’ll show fight once we lay our hands on him; for
he hasn’t an earthly chance of getting away.”

He poked about among the sedge on the rim of the lakelet and at last
discovered the decrepit raft.

“This thing’ll just bear two of us. Do we dig the beggar out or starve
him out? Dig him out, eh? Well, I want some one to go with me. Here,
you, Frankie”—he turned to the Prehistoric Man—“you’d better come
along. If it comes to a ducking, you’ve got fewer clothes to spoil
than the rest of us.”

Nothing loath, the Prehistoric Man scrambled aboard the raft, which
sank ominously under the extra weight.

“I can’t find anything to pole with,” grumbled Michael. “Paddle with
your flippers, Frankie. It’s the only thing to do. Get busy with it.”

Under this primitive method of propulsion, the progress of the raft
was slow; but at last they succeeded in bringing it under the
cliff-face, after which they were able to work it along by hand.
Gradually they manœuvred it into position in front of the cave-mouth,
which stood only a yard or so above water-level. Michael leaned
forward to the entrance.

“You may as well come out quietly,” he warned the inmate. “It’s no
good trying to put up a fight. You haven’t a dog’s chance.”

There was no reply of any sort.

“Hold the damned raft steady, Frankie! You nearly had me overboard,”
expostulated Michael. “I’m going to light a match. The cave’s as black
as the pit, and I can see nothing.”

He pulled a silver match-box from his trousers pocket.

“Lucky I hadn’t this in my coat; for you don’t look as if you had a
pocket of any sort on you, Frankie.”

The first match, damped by the moisture on his hands, sputtered and
died out.

“_Hurry_ up, Guvnor,” shouted Mephistopheles, cheerfully, from the
bank. “Don’t keep us up all night with your firework display. It’s
getting a bit chilly, paddling about amongst this sedge. Not at all
the temperature I’m accustomed to at home.”

Michael felt for another match and lighted it successfully. Standing
up on the raft, he held the light above his head and peered into the
cavity in the rock. The Prehistoric Man heard him exclaim in
amazement.

“Damnation, Frankie! He’s not here! It’s hardly a cave at all.”

He put his hands on the cave floor.

“Hold tight with the raft. I’m going in to make sure.”

He scrambled up into the hollow; but almost immediately his face
appeared again in the moonlight.

“Nothing here. The hole’s barely big enough to take me in.”

“Then where’s he gone?” demanded the Prehistoric Man, who was a
creature of few words.

“I dunno! Must have given us the slip somehow. If he isn’t here, he
must be somewhere else. No getting round that.”

He shouted the news to the watchers on the banks; and a confused sound
of argument rose from amongst the sedge.

“Not much use hanging round the old home, Frankie. Pull for shore,
sailor. We’d best manhandle her along the face of the cliff. I’ve had
enough of that paddling.”

When they touched firm ground again they were surrounded by their
friends, most of whom seemed to doubt whether the search of the cave
had been properly carried out.

“I tell you,” declaimed the exasperated Michael, “I got right into the
damned hole! It’s so small that I nearly broke my nose against the
back wall as I heaved myself inside. It would have been a tight fit
for me and a squirrel together. He’s not there, whether you like it or
not. . . . I can’t help your troubles, Tommy; you can go and look for
yourself, if you like the job of lying on your tummy on a raft that’s
awash. I shan’t interfere with your simple pleasures.”

“But . . .”

“We’ve lost him. Is that plain enough? There’s nothing to be done but
go home again with our tails between our legs. I’m going now.”

He accompanied his friends to the top of the cliff again; but when he
reached the terrace a fresh thought struck him, and he loitered behind
while the others, soaked and disconsolate, made their way down into
the pine-wood. When the last of them had disappeared, Michael retraced
his steps to the edge of the cliff.

“He reached here all right,” he assured himself. “And he didn’t break
back through the cordon.”

He stooped down, picked up the rope, and refastened it round one of
the pillars of the balustrade.

“Every one knows there are secret passages about Ravensthorpe,” he
mused. “Perhaps this beggar has got on to one of them. And quite
possibly the end of the passage is in that cave down there. That would
explain the rope. I’ll slide down and have another look round.”

He got into the cave-mouth without difficulty and used up the
remainder of his matches in a close examination of the interior of the
cavity; but even the closest scrutiny failed to reveal anything to his
eyes.

“Nothing there but plain rock, so far as I can see,” he had to admit
to himself as the last match burned out. “That’s a blank end in more
senses than one.”

Without much difficulty he swarmed up the rope again, untied it from
the balustrade, and coiled it over his arm.

“A nice little clue for Sir Clinton Driffield to puzzle over,” he
assured himself. “Sherlock Holmes would have been on to it at once;
found where it was sold in no time; discovered who bought it before
five minutes had passed; and paralysed Watson with the whole story
that same evening over a pipeful of shag. We shall see.”

He threw a last glance round the empty terrace and then moved off
into the spinney. As he passed into the shadow of the trees he saw,
a few yards to one side, the outline of the Fairy House dappled
in the moonshine which filtered through the leaves overhead.
Half-unconsciously, Michael halted and looked at the little building.

“They could never have overlooked that in the hunt, surely. Well, no
harm in having a peep to make certain.”

He dropped his coil of rope, stepped across to the house, and,
stooping down, flung open the door. Inside, he caught a flash of some
white fabric.

“It’s the beggar after all! Here! Come out of that!”

He gripped the inmate roughly and hauled him by main force out of his
retreat.

“Pierrot costume, right enough!” he said to himself as he extracted
the man little by little from his refuge. Then, having got his victim
into the open:

“Now we’ll turn you over and have a look at your face . . . Good God!
Maurice!”

For as he turned the man on his back, it was the face of Maurice
Chacewater that met his eyes. But it was not a normal Maurice whom he
saw. The features were contorted by some excessive emotion the like of
which Michael had never seen.

“Let me alone, damn you,” Maurice gasped, and turned over once more on
his face, resting his brow on his arm as though to shut out the
spectacle of Michael’s astonishment.

“Are you ill?” Michael inquired, solicitously.

“For God’s sake leave me alone. Don’t stand there gaping. Clear out, I
tell you.”

Michael looked at him in amazement.

“I’m going to have a cheerful kind of brother-in-law before all’s
done, it seems,” he thought to himself.

“Can I do anything for you, Maurice?”

“Oh, go to hell!”

Michael turned away.

“It’s fairly clear he doesn’t like my company,” he reflected, as he
stepped across and picked up his coil of rope from the ground. “But
I’ve known politer ways of showing it, I must say.”

With a final glance at the prostrate figure of Maurice, he walked on
and took the road back to Ravensthorpe. But as he went a vision of
Maurice’s face kept passing before his mind’s eye.

“There’s something damned far wrong with that beggar, whether it’s an
evil conscience or cramp in the tummy. It might be either of them, by
the look of him. He didn’t seem to want any assistance from me. That
looks more like the evil conscience theory.”

He dismissed this with a laugh; but gradually he grew troubled.

“There he was, in white—same as the burglar. He’s in a bit of a bate
at being discovered, that’s clear enough. He didn’t half like it, to
judge by his chat.”

A discomforting hypothesis began to frame itself in his mind despite
his efforts to stifle it.

“He’s the fellow, if there is one, who would know all these secret
passages about here. Suppose there really is one leading out of that
cave. He could have swarmed down the rope, got into the cave, sneaked
up the subterranean passage, and got behind us that way.”

A fresh fact fitted suddenly in.

“And of course the other end of the passage may be in that Fairy
House! That would explain his being there. He’d be waiting to see us
off the premises before he could venture out in his white costume.”

He pondered over the problem as he hurried with long strides towards
the house.

“Well,” he concluded, “I’m taking no further steps in the business.
It’s no concern of mine to go probing into the private affairs of the
family I’m going to marry into. And that’s that.”

Then, as a fresh aspect of the matter came to his mind, he gave a sigh
of relief.

“I must be a stricken idiot! No man would ever dream of burgling his
own house. What would he gain by it, if he did? The thing’s
ridiculous.”

And the comfort which this view brought him was sufficient to lighten
his steps for the rest of his way.



CHAPTER V

Sir Clinton in the Museum

“There’s the light on again in the museum,” Sir Clinton observed. “I
think we’ll go in and have a look round, now, to see if the place
suggests anything.”

Mold stood aside to let them pass, and then resumed his watch at the
door to prevent any one else from entering the room. The servant had
just finished fitting the new globe in its place and was preparing to
remove the steps which he had used, when Sir Clinton ordered him to
leave them in position and to await further instructions.

The museum was a room about forty feet square, with a lofty ceiling.
To judge by the panelling of the walls, it belonged to the older part
of Ravensthorpe; but the parquet of the floor seemed to be much more
modern. Round the sides were placed exhibition cases about six feet
high; and others of the same kind jutted out at intervals to form a
series of shallow bays. In the centre of the room, directly under the
lamp, stood a long, flat-topped case; and the floor beside it was
littered with broken glass.

“I think we’ll begin at the beginning,” said Sir Clinton.

He turned to the servant who stood waiting beside the steps.

“Have you got the remains of the broken lamp there?

“You can go now,” he added. “We shan’t need you further.”

When he had received the smashed lamp, he examined it.

“Not much to be made out of that,” he admitted. “It’s been one of
these thousand candle-power gas-filled things; and there’s practically
nothing left of it but the metal base and a few splinters of glass
sticking to it.”

He looked up at the fresh lamp hanging above them.

“It’s thirty feet or so above the floor. Nothing short of a
fishing-rod would reach it. Evidently they didn’t smash it by hand.”

He stooped down and sorted out one or two small fragments of glass
from the debris at his feet.

“These are more bits of the lamp, Joan,” he said, holding them out for
her to look at. “You see the curve of the glass; and you’ll notice
that the whole affair seems to have been smashed almost to
smithereens. There doesn’t seem to be a decent-sized fragment in the
whole lot.”

He turned to the keeper.

“I think we’ll shut the door, Mold. We’d better conduct the rest of
this business in private.”

The keeper closed the door of the museum, much to the disappointment
of the group of people who had clustered about the entrance and were
watching the proceedings with interest.

“Now, Joan, would you mind going round the wall-cases and seeing if
anything has been taken from them?”

Joan obediently paced round the room and soon came back to report that
nothing seemed to have been removed.

“All the cases were locked, you know,” she explained. “And there’s no
glass broken in any of them. So far as I can see, nothing’s missing
from the shelves.”

“What about that safe let into the wall over yonder?” Sir Clinton
inquired.

“It’s used to house one or two extra valuable things from time to
time,” Joan explained. “But to-night everything was put on show, and
the safe’s empty.”

She went over and swung the door open, showing the vacant shelves
within.

“We do take precautions usually,” she pointed out. “The museum door
itself is iron-plated and has a special lock. It was only to-night
that we had everything out in the show-cases.”

Sir Clinton refrained from comment, as he knew the girl was still
blaming herself for her share in the catastrophe. He turned to examine
the rifled section of the central case.

“What’s missing here, Joan, can you make out?”

Obediently, Joan came to his side and ran her eye over the remaining
articles in the compartment.

“They’ve taken the Medusa Medallions!” she exclaimed, turning pale as
she realized the magnitude of the calamity. “They’ve got the very pick
of the collection, Sir Clinton. My father would have parted with all
the rest rather than with these, I know.”

“Nothing else gone?”

Joan looked again at the case.

“No, nothing else, so far as I can see. Wait a bit, though! They’ve
taken the electrotype copies as well. There were three of each: three
medallions and an electrotype from each that Foxton Polegate made for
us. The whole six are gone.”

She cast a final glance at the compartment.

“No, there’s nothing else missing, so far as I can see. Some of the
things are displaced a bit; but everything except the medallions and
the electros seems to be here.”

“You’re quite sure?”

“Certain.”

Sir Clinton seemed satisfied.

“Of course we’ll have to check the stuff by the catalogue to make
sure,” he said, “but I expect you’re right. The medallions alone would
be quite a good enough haul for a minute or two’s work; and probably
they had their eyes on the things as the best paying proposition of
the lot.”

“But why did they take the electros as well?” Joan demanded.

Then a possible explanation occurred to her.

“Oh, of course, they wouldn’t know which was which, so they took the
lot in order to make sure.”

“Possibly,” Sir Clinton admitted. “But don’t let’s be going too fast,
Joan. We’d better not get ideas into our minds till we’ve got all the
evidence, you know.”

“Oh, I see,” said Joan, with a faint return of her normal spirits,
“I’m to be Watson, am I? And you’ll prove in a minute or two what an
ass I’ve made of myself. Is that the idea?”

“Not altogether,” Sir Clinton returned, with a smile. “But let’s have
the facts before the theories.”

He turned to the keeper.

“Now we’ll take your story, Mold; but give us the things in the exact
order in which they happened, if you can. And don’t be worried if I
break in with questions.”

Mold thought for a moment or two before beginning his tale.

“I’m trying to remember how many people there were in the room just
before the lights went out,” he explained at last, “but somehow I
don’t quite seem able to put a figure on it, Sir Clinton. I’ve a sort
of feeling that some of ’em must ha’ got away before I stopped the
door—sneaked off in the dark. At least I know I felt surprised when I
saw how few I’d got left when they began to come up to me to be let
out. But that’s all I can really say, sir.”

Sir Clinton evidently approved of the keeper’s caution.

“Now tell us exactly what happened when the light went out. This is
the bit where I want you to be careful. Tell us everything you can
remember.”

Mold fixed his eye on the corner of the room near the safe.

“I was patrollin’ round the room, sir, most of the night. I didn’t
stand in one place all the time. Now just when the light was about to
go out, I was walkin’ away from this case here”—he nodded towards the
rifled central case—“and as near as may be, I’d got to the entrance to
that second-last bay, just before you come to the safe. I just turned
round to come back, when I heard a pistol goin’ off.”

“That was the first thing that attracted your attention?” questioned
Sir Clinton. “It’s an important point, Mold.”

“That was the first thing out o’ the common that happened,” Mold
asserted. “The pistol went bang, and out went the light, and I heard
glass tinkling all over the place.”

“Shot the light out, did they?” Sir Clinton mused.

He glanced up at the carved wooden ceiling, but evidently failed to
find what he was looking for.

“Have you a pair of race-glasses, Joan? Prismatics, or even
opera-glasses? Tell Mold where he can get them, please.”

Joan gave the keeper instructions and he left the room.

“Knock when you come back again,” Sir Clinton ordered. “I’m going to
lock the door to keep out the inquisitive.”

As soon as the keeper was out of earshot, Sir Clinton turned to Joan.

“This fellow Mold, is he a reliable man? Do you know anything about
him, Joan?”

“He’s our head keeper. We’ve always trusted him completely.”

She glanced at Sir Clinton, trying to read the expression on his face.

“You don’t think _he’s_ at the bottom of the business, do you? I never
thought of that!”

“I’m only collecting facts at present. All I want to know is whether
you know Mold to be reliable.”

“We’ve always found him so.”

“Good. We’ll make a note of that; and if we get the thing cleared up,
then we’ll perhaps be able to confirm that opinion of yours.”

In a few minutes a knock came at the door and Sir Clinton admitted the
keeper.

“Prismatics?” he said, taking the glasses from Mold. “They’ll do quite
well.”

Adjusting the focus, he subjected the ceiling of the room to a minute
scrutiny. At last he handed the glasses to Joan.

“Look up there,” he said, indicating the position.

Joan swept the place with the glasses for a moment.

“I see,” she said. “That’s a bullet-hole in the wood, isn’t it?”

Sir Clinton confirmed her guess.

“That’s evidently where the bullet went after knocking the lamp to
pieces. Pull the steps over there, Mold. I want to have a closer look
at the thing.”

With some difficulty, owing to his injured ankle, he ascended the
steps and inspected the tiny cavity.

“It looks like a .22 calibre. One could carry a Colt pistol of that
size in one’s pocket and no one would notice it.”

His eye traced out the line joining the bullet-mark and the lamp.

“The shot was evidently fired by some one in that bay over there,” he
inferred. “Just go to where you were standing when the light went out,
Mold. Can you see into this bay here?”

Mold looked around and discovered that a show-case interposed between
him and the point from which the pistol had been fired.

“They evidently thought of everything,” Sir Clinton said, when he
heard Mold’s report. “If a man had brandished his pistol in front of
Mold, there was always a chance that Mold might have remembered his
costume. Firing from that hiding-place, he was quite safe, and could
take time over his aim if he wanted to.”

He climbed down the steps and verified the matter by going to the
position from which the shot had been fired. It was evident that the
shooter was out of sight of the keeper at the actual moment of the
discharge.

“Now what happened after that, Mold?” Sir Clinton demanded, coming
back to the central case again.

Mold scratched his ear as though reflecting, then hurriedly took his
hand down again.

“This pistol went off, sir; and the lamp-glass tinkled all over the
place. I got a start—who wouldn’t?—with the light going out, and all.
Before I could move an inch, some one got a grip of my wrists and
swung me round. He twisted my arms behind my back and I couldn’t do
anything but kick—and not much kickin’ even, or I’d have gone down on
my face.”

“Did you manage to get home on him at all?”

“I think I kicked him once, sir; but it was only a graze.”

“Pity,” Sir Clinton said. “It would have always been something gained
if you’d marked him with a good bruise.”

“Oh, there’ll be a mark, if that’s all you want, sir. But it wouldn’t
prevent him runnin’ at all.”

“And then?” Sir Clinton brought Mold back to his story.

“Then, almost at once when the lights went out, I heard glass
breakin’—just as if you’d heaved a stone through a window. It seemed
to me—but I couldn’t take my oath on it—as if there was two smashes,
one after t’other. I couldn’t be sure. Then there was a lot of
scufflin’ in the dark; but who did it, I couldn’t rightly say. I was
busy tryin’ to get free from the man who was holdin’ me then.”

Sir Clinton moved over to the rifled compartment and inspected the
broken glass thoughtfully for a moment or two.

“Are you looking for finger-marks?” asked Joan, as she came to his
side.

Sir Clinton shook his head.

“Not much use hunting for finger-marks round here. Remember how many
people must have leaned on this case at one time or other during the
evening, when they were looking at the collection before the robbery.
Finger-prints would prove nothing against any one in particular, I’m
afraid, Joan. What I’m really trying to find is some evidence
confirming Mold’s notion that he heard two smashes after the light
went out. It certainly looks as if he were right. If you look at the
way that bit of glass there is cracked, you’ll see two series of lines
in it. It might have been cracked here”—he pointed with his
finger—“first of all: long cracks radiating from a smash over in this
direction. Then there was a second blow—about here—which snapped off
the apices of the spears of glass left after the first smash. But that
really proves nothing. The same man might easily have hit the pane
twice.”

He turned back to the keeper.

“Can you give me an estimate, Mold, of how long it was between the two
crashes you heard?”

Mold considered carefully before replying.

“So far’s I can remember, Sir Clinton, it was about five seconds. But
I’ll not take my oath on it.”

“I wish you could be surer,” said the Chief Constable. “If it really
was five seconds, it certainly looks like two separate affairs. A man
smashing glass with repeated blows wouldn’t wait five seconds between
them.”

He scanned the broken glass again.

“There’s a lot of jagged stuff round the edge of the hole but no
blood, so far as I can see. The fellow must have worn a thick glove if
he got his hand in there in the dark without cutting himself in the
hurry.”

He turned back to the keeper.

“You can go outside, Mold, and keep people off the doorstep for a
minute or two. Perhaps we shall have news of the man-hunt soon. If any
one wants to see me on business; let him in; but keep off casual
inquirers for the present.”

Obediently Mold unlocked the door and took his stand on the threshold
outside, shutting the door behind him as he went. When he had gone,
Sir Clinton turned to Joan.

“Were these medallions insured, do you know?”

Fortunately, Joan was able to supply some information.

“Maurice insured them, I know. But I’ve heard him say that he wasn’t
content with the valuation put on them by the company. It seems they
wouldn’t take his word for the value of the things—they thought it was
a speculative one or something—and in case of a loss they weren’t
prepared to go beyond a figure which Maurice thought too small.”

“The electros weren’t insured for any great amount, I suppose?”

Joan shook her head.

“I don’t think they were specially insured. They were just put under
the ordinary house policy, I think. But you’d better ask Maurice. He
knows all about it.”

Sir Clinton glanced round the room once more.

“I doubt if there’s much more to find out here,” he concluded. “It
doesn’t give us much to go on, does it? Perhaps we’ll have better luck
when these fellows come in from their hunt. They may have some news
for us. But as things stand, we can’t even be sure whether it was two
men or two gangs that were at work. One can’t blame Mold for not
giving us better information; but what he gave us doesn’t seem to
amount to very much at present.”

He turned, as though to leave the room; but at that moment the door
opened and Mold appeared.

“There’s a Mr. Foss wants to see you, sir. He says he’s got something
to tell you that won’t wait. He’s been looking for you all over the
house.”

“That’s the American, isn’t it?” Sir Clinton asked Joan in a low
voice.

“Yes. He’s been here for a day or two, consulting with Maurice about
these medallions.”

“Well, if he can throw any light on this business, I suppose we’d
better let him in and see what he has to say. You needn’t go, Joan.
You may as well hear his story, whatever it may be.”

He turned to the keeper.

“Let Mr. Foss in, Mold; and wait outside the door yourself.”



CHAPTER VI

Mr. Foss’s Explanation

Mr. Foss had nothing distinctively American in his appearance, Sir
Clinton noted; and when he spoke, his accent was so faint as to be
hardly detectable. He was a stout man of about fifty, with a
clean-shaven face and more than a trace of a double chin: the kind of
man who might readily be chosen as an unofficial uncle by children.
Sir Clinton’s first glance showed him that the American was troubled
about something.

Foss seemed surprised to find the Chief Constable in the guise of
Prospero. He himself, in preparation for an official interview, had
exchanged his masquerade costume for ordinary evening clothes.

“We haven’t met before, Sir Clinton,” he explained, rather
unnecessarily, “but I’ve something to tell you”—his face clouded
slightly—“which I felt you ought to know before you go any further in
this business. I’ve been hunting all over the house for you; and it
was only a minute or two ago that I got directed in here.”

“Yes?” said Sir Clinton, interrogatively.

Foss glanced at Joan and seemed to find some difficulty in opening the
subject.

“It’s a strictly private matter,” he explained.

Joan refused to take the implied hint.

“If it has any connection with this burglary, Mr. Foss, I see no
reason why I should not hear what you have to say. It’s a matter that
concerns me as one of the family, you know.”

Foss seemed taken aback and quite evidently he would have preferred to
make his confidence to Sir Clinton alone.

“It’s rather a difficult matter,” he said, with a feeble endeavour to
deflect Joan from her purpose.

Joan, however, took no notice of his diffidence.

“Come, Mr. Foss,” she said. “If it’s really important, the sooner Sir
Clinton hears of it the better. Begin.”

Foss glanced appealingly at Sir Clinton; but apparently the Chief
Constable took Joan’s view of the matter.

“I’m rather busy at present, Mr. Foss,” he said, dryly. “Perhaps
you’ll give us your information as concisely as possible.”

Having failed in his attempt, Foss made the best of it; though it was
with obvious reluctance that he launched into his subject.

“Last night after dinner,” he began, “I went into the winter-garden to
smoke a cigar. I had some business affairs which I wanted to put
straight in my mind; and I thought I could stow myself away in a
corner there and be free from interruption. So I sat down at one side
of the winter-garden behind a large clump of palms where no one was
likely to see me; and I began to think over the points I had in mind.”

“Yes?” prompted Sir Clinton, who seemed anxious to cut Foss’s
narrative down to essentials.

“While I was sitting there,” the American continued, “some of the
young people came into the winter-garden and sat down in a recess on
the side opposite to where I was. At first they didn’t disturb me. I
thought they’d be almost out of earshot, on the other side of the
dome. I think you were one of them, Miss Chacewater: you, and your
brother, and Miss Rainhill, and some one else whom I didn’t
recognize.”

“I was there,” Joan confirmed, looking rather puzzled as to what might
come next.

“You may not know, Miss Chacewater,” Foss continued, “that your
winter-garden is a sort of whispering-gallery. Although I was quite a
long way off from your party, your voices came quite clearly across to
where I was sitting. They didn’t disturb me at all—I’ve got the knack
of concentration when I’m thinking about business affairs. But
although I wasn’t listening intentionally, the whole conversation was
getting in at my ear while I was thinking about other things. I
suppose I ought to have gone away or let you know I was there; but the
fact is, I’d just got to a point where I was seeing my way through a
rather knotty tangle, and I didn’t want to break my chain of thought.
I wasn’t eavesdropping, you understand?”

“Yes?” repeated Sir Clinton, with a slight acidity in his tone. “And
then?”

But the American failed to take the hint. Evidently he laid great
stress on explaining exactly how things had fallen out.

“After a while,” he went on, with an evident effort to be accurate,
“Miss Chacewater and some one else left the party.”

“Quite true,” Joan confirmed. “We went to play billiards.”

The American nodded.

“When you had gone,” he continued, “some one else joined the party—a
red-haired young man whom they called Foxy.”

Sir Clinton glanced at Joan.

“That’s Foxton Polegate,” Joan explained. “He’s a neighbour of ours.
He made these electrotypes of the medallions for us.”

Foss waited patiently till she had finished her interjection. Then he
resumed his narrative.

“Shortly after that, my ear caught the sound of my own name. Naturally
my attention was attracted, quite without any intention on my part.
It’s only natural to prick up your ears when you hear your own name
mentioned.”

He looked apologetically at them both as if asking them to condone his
conduct.

“The next thing I heard—without listening intentionally, you
understand?—was ‘Medusa Medallions.’ Now, as you know, I’ve been sent
over here by Mr. Kessock to see if I can arrange to buy these
medallions from Mr. Chacewater. It’s my duty to my employer to get to
know all I can about them. I wouldn’t be earning my money if I spared
any trouble in the work which has been put into my hands. So when I
heard the name of the medallions mentioned, I . . . frankly, I
listened with both ears. It seemed to me my duty to Mr. Kessock to do
so.”

He looked appealingly at their faces as though to plead for a
favourable verdict on his conduct.

“Go on, please,” Sir Clinton requested.

“I hardly expected you’d look on it as I do,” Foss confessed rather
shamefacedly. “Of course, it was just plain eavesdropping on my part
by that time. But I felt Mr. Kessock would have expected me to find
out all I could about these medallions. To be candid, I’d do the same
again; though I didn’t like doing it.”

Sir Clinton seemed to feel that he had been rather discouraging.

“I shouldn’t make too much of it, Mr. Foss. What happened next?”

Foss’s face showed that he was at last coming to a matter of real
difficulty.

“It’s rather unfortunate that I came to be mixed up in the thing at
all,” he said, with obvious chagrin. “I can assure you, Miss
Chacewater, that I don’t like doing it. I only made up my mind to tell
you about it because it seems to me to give a chance of hushing this
supposed burglary up quietly before there’s any talk goes round.”

“_Supposed_ burglary,” exclaimed Joan. “What’s your idea of a real
burglary, if this sort of thing is only a supposed one?”

She indicated the shattered show-case and the litter of glass on the
floor.

Foss evidently decided to take the rest of his narrative in a rush.

“I’ll tell you,” he said. “The next thing I overheard was a complete
plan for a fake burglary—a practical joke—to be carried out to-night.
The light in here was to be put out; the house-lights were to be
extinguished: and in the darkness, your brother and this Mr. Foxy
How-d’you-call-him were to get away with the medallions.”

“Ah, Mr. Foss, now you become interesting,” Sir Clinton acknowledged.

“I heard all the details,” Foss went on. “How Miss Rainhill was to see
to extinguishing the lights; how Mr. Chacewater was to secure the
keeper; and how meanwhile his friend was to put on a thick glove and
take the medallions out of the case there. And it seems to me that it
was a matter that interested me directly,” he added, dropping his air
of apology, “for I gathered that the whole affair was planned with
some idea of making this sale to Mr. Kessock fall through at the last
moment.”

“Indeed?”

Sir Clinton’s face showed that at last he saw something more clearly
than before.

“That was the motive,” Foss continued. “Now the whole thing put me in
a most awkward position.”

“I think I see your difficulty,” Sir Clinton assured him, with more
geniality than he had hitherto shown.

“It was very hard to make up my mind what to do,” Foss went on.
“I’m a guest here. This was a family joke, apparently—one brother
taking a rise out of another. It was hardly for me to step in and
perhaps cause bad feelings between them. I thought the whole thing
was perhaps just talk—not meant seriously in the end. A kind of
‘how-would-we-do-it-if-we-set-about-it’ discussion, you understand.”

Sir Clinton nodded understandingly.

“Difficult to know what to do, in your shoes, undoubtedly.”

Foss was obviously relieved by the Chief Constable’s comprehension.

“I thought it over,” he continued, with a less defensive tone in his
voice, “and it seemed to me that the soundest course was to let
sleeping dogs lie—to let them lie, at any rate, until they woke up and
bit somebody. I made up my mind I’d say nothing about the matter at
all, unless something really did happen.”

“Very judicious,” Sir Clinton acquiesced.

“Then came to-night,” Foss resumed. “Their plan went through. I don’t
know what success they had—the house is full of all sorts of rumours.
But I heard that the Chief Constable was on the spot and was taking up
the case himself; and as soon as I heard that, I felt I ought to tell
what I knew. So I hunted you out, so as to avoid your taking any steps
before you knew just how the land lay. It’s only a practical joke and
not a crime at all. I don’t know anything about your English laws, and
I was afraid you might be taking some steps, doing something or other
that would make it impossible to stop short of the whole affair coming
out in public. I’m sure the family wouldn’t like that.”

He glanced at Joan’s face, but evidently found nothing very
encouraging in her expression.

“It’s been a most unfortunate position for me,” he complained.

Sir Clinton took pity on him.

“It was very good of you to give me these facts,” he said with more
cordiality than he had hitherto shown. “You’ve cleared up the thing
and saved us from putting our foot in it badly, perhaps. Thanks very
much for your trouble, Mr. Foss. You’ve been of great assistance.”

His tone showed that the interview was at an end; but, tactfully, as
though to spare the obviously ruffled feelings of the American, he
accompanied him to the door. When Foss had left the room, Sir Clinton
turned back to Joan.

“Well, Joan, what about it?”

“Oh, it sounds accurate enough,” Joan admitted, though there was an
undercurrent of resentment in her tone. “Foss couldn’t have known what
sort of person Foxy is; and it’s as clear as daylight that Foxy was at
the bottom of this. He’s a silly ass who’s always playing practical
jokes.”

She paused for a moment. Then relief showed itself in her voice as she
added:

“It’s rather a blessing to know the whole affair has been just spoof,
isn’t it? You can hush it up easily enough, can’t you? Nobody need
know exactly what happened; and then we’ll be all right. If this story
comes out, all our little family bickerings will be common talk; and
one doesn’t want that. I’m not exactly proud of the way Maurice has
been treating Cecil.”

Sir Clinton’s face showed that he understood her position; but, rather
to her surprise, he gave no verbal assurance.

“It _is_ all right!” she demanded.

“I think we’ll interview your friend Foxy first of all,” Sir Clinton
proposed, taking no notice of her inquiry.

Going to the door, he gave some orders to the keeper.

“You were rather stiff with our good Mr. Foss,” he said, turning to
Joan as he closed the door again. “What would you have done yourself,
if you’d been in his position?”

Joan had her answer ready.

“I suppose he couldn’t help overhearing things; but when this affair
came to light, I think if I’d been in his shoes I’d have gone to Cecil
instead of coming to us with the tale. Once Cecil found the game was
up, he’d have been able to return the medallions in some way or other,
without raising any dust.”

“That was one way, certainly.”

“What I object to is Foss coming to you,” Joan explained. “He didn’t
know you’re an old friend of ours. All he knew was that you were the
Chief Constable. So off he hies to you, post-haste, to give the whole
show away; when he might quite well have come to me or gone to Cecil.
I don’t like this way of doing things—no tact at all.”

“I can’t conceive how Cecil came to take up a silly prank like this,”
said Sir Clinton. “It’s a schoolboy’s trick.”

“You don’t know everything,” said Joan, in defence of her brother.

“I know a good deal, Joan,” Sir Clinton retorted in a decisive tone.
“Perhaps I know more than you think about this business.”

In a few minutes the keeper knocked at the door.

“Well?” demanded Sir Clinton, opening it.

“I can’t find Mr. Polegate anywhere, sir,” Mold reported. “No one’s
seen him; and he’s not in the house.”

“He was here to-night,” Joan declared. “I recognized him when I was
dancing with him. You can’t mistake that shock of hair; and of course
his voice gave him away when he spoke.”

Sir Clinton did not seem perturbed.

“Bring Mr. Cecil, Mold,” he ordered, and locked the door again as the
keeper went off on his fresh errand.

This task Mold completed in a very short time. Sir Clinton opened at
his knock and Cecil Chacewater came into the museum. He was dressed as
a Swiss admiral and behind him came Una Rainhill in the costume of
Cleopatra.

Sir Clinton wasted no time in preliminaries.

“I’ve sent for you, Cecil, because I want to know exactly what part
you played in this business to-night.”

Cecil Chacewater opened his eyes in astonishment.

“You seem to be a bit of a super-sleuth! How did you spot us so
quickly?”

Quite obviously Cecil was not greatly perturbed at being found out, as
Sir Clinton noted with a certain relief. So far as he was concerned,
the thing had been only a prank.

“Tell me exactly what happened after you came in here before the
lights went out,” the Chief Constable demanded in a curt tone.

Cecil glanced at Una. Sir Clinton caught the look.

“We know all about Miss Rainhill’s part in the affair,” he explained
bluntly.

“Oh, in that case,” said Cecil, “there’s no particular reason why I
should keep back anything. Una, Foxy, and I planned it between us. I
take full responsibility for that. I wanted to upset this sale, if I
could. I’m not ashamed of that.”

“I know all about that,” Sir Clinton pointed out, coldly. “What I wish
to know is exactly what happened after you came in here to steal these
medallions.”

Cecil seemed impressed by the Chief Constable’s tone.

“I’ll tell you, then. We’ve nothing to conceal. I came in here at
about twenty to twelve and sauntered about the room, pretending to
look at the cases as if I’d never seen them before. My part was to
mark down Mold and prevent him interfering.”

Sir Clinton nodded to show that he knew all this.

“Rather before I expected it, the light went out. Oh, there was a shot
fired just then. I didn’t understand that part of it, but I supposed
that Foxy had brought a pistol with him and fired a blank cartridge
just to add a touch of interest to the affair. It wasn’t on the bill
of fare, so I imagine it must have been one of these last-minute
improvements. Anyhow, I did my part of the business: jumped on Mold
and held him while Foxy got away with the stuff. Then, when he’d had
time to get away, I let Mold go and made a bee-line for the door
myself. I could swear no one spotted me in the dark, and I was well
mixed up in the mob before the lights went on again.”

“Did you pay particular attention to what Polegate was doing while you
were busy with the keeper?”

“No. Mold gave me all I wanted in the way of trouble.”

“You’re sure it was Mold you got hold of? You didn’t make any
mistake?”

Cecil reflected for a moment.

“I don’t see how I could have gripped the wrong man. I’d marked him
down while the light was on.”

“Can you remember anything about sounds of breaking glass?”

Cecil pondered before replying.

“It seemed to me that there was a lot of glass-breaking—more than I’d
expected. The light was hardly out before there was a smash and tinkle
all over the place. Foxy must have got to work quicker than I’d
allowed for. And I remember hearing quite a lot of hammering and
smashing going on after that, as if he’d found it difficult to make a
big enough hole in the glass of the case. I thought he’d bungled the
business, and it was all I could do to keep my grip on Mold long
enough to get the thing safely through.”

Sir Clinton dismissed that part of the subject. He turned to Una.

“Now, Miss Rainhill, I believe your part in the affair was to pull out
the main switch of the house?”

“Yes,” Una admitted, looking rather surprised at the extent of his
knowledge.

“Did you carry out your part of the arrangement punctually, or were
you late in getting the current off?”

“I pulled out the switch to the very second. I had my hand on it and
my eye on my wrist-watch; and when it came to 11.45 I jerked it out
and the lights went off. I was absolutely right to a second, I’m
sure.”

“And you thought Miss Rainhill had been a shade before her time,
Cecil?”

“So it seemed to me. I hadn’t a chance of looking at my watch; and of
course after the lights went off I couldn’t spare time to look.”

At this moment another knock came to the door and Foxy Polegate burst
into the museum. Sir Clinton noticed that he was masquerading as a
Harlequin.

“Heard you’d been asking for me, Sir Clinton,” he broke out as he came
into the room. “Seems the keeper had been inquiring for me. So I came
along as soon as I heard about it.”

He glanced inquisitively at Cecil and Una, as though wondering what
they were doing there.

Sir Clinton wasted no words.

“The medallions, Mr. Polegate, please.”

Foxy made a very good pretence of astonishment at the demand; but
Cecil cut him short.

“You may as well hand them over, Foxy. They seem to know all about the
joke.”

“Oh, they do, do they?” Foxy exclaimed. “They seem to have been mighty
swift about it. That little joke’s gone astray, evidently.”

He seemed completely taken aback by the exposure.

“The medallions?” he repeated. “I’ll get ’em for you in a jiffy.”

He walked across to the show-case, fumbled for a moment at the flat
base near one of the legs, and from below this he drew out three
medallions.

“Stuck ’em there with plasticine as soon as I’d got ’em. After that
any one would have turned out my pockets if they’d wanted, see?”

Sir Clinton held out his hand and took the medallions from Foxy. For a
moment or two he examined them, then he passed them to Cecil.

“Have you any way of telling easily whether these are the real things
or the replicas?”

Cecil inspected them one by one with minute care.

“These are the real things,” he announced. “What else could they be?”

“You’ve no doubt about it?” questioned Sir Clinton.

“Not a bit,” Cecil assured him. “When Foxy made the replicas, my
father had a tiny hole—just a dot—drilled in the edge of each
electrotype so as to distinguish the real things from the sham. There
are no holes here; so these are the real Leonardos.”

Sir Clinton swung round suddenly on Foxy.

“Now, Mr. Polegate,” he said, sternly, “you’ve given a lot of trouble
with this silly joke of yours. I’m not concerned with your taste in
humour, or I might say a few things you wouldn’t care to hear. But you
can repair the damage to some extent if you give me a frank account of
your doings in here to-night. I want the whole story, please.”

Foxy was evidently completely taken aback by Sir Clinton’s tone.

“Come, we’re waiting. There’s no time to lose,” Sir Clinton said,
curtly, as Foxy seemed to hesitate. Joan and the others showed by
their faces that they could not quite understand the reason for the
Chief Constable’s asperity.

“We planned that . . .”

“I know all about that,” said Sir Clinton, brusquely. “Begin at the
point where you came in here at twenty to twelve or so.”

Foxy pulled himself together. The Chief Constable’s manner was not
encouraging.

“I came in here as arranged, and worked my way over to the central
case there—slowly, so as not to attract the keeper’s attention. One or
two other people were hanging round it then, too. I remember noticing
a chap in a white Pierrot costume alongside me. Suddenly there was a
pistol-shot and the light went out according to plan.”

“How do you account for the pistol-shot?” demanded Sir Clinton.

“Try next door,” said Foxy. “I thought it was a fancy tip that Cecil
had thrown in at the last moment. It wasn’t in the book of words.”

“You were ready to get to work when the light went out?” inquired Sir
Clinton.

Foxy considered for a moment.

“It took me rather by surprise,” he admitted. “I’d counted on having
at least another minute, according to the time-table.”

“What happened next? Be careful now.”

“As soon as the light went out, I pulled on a thick pair of gloves and
got a bit of lead pipe out of my slapstick. But there was a bit of a
scuffle in the dark round the show-case, and some one must have put
their elbow through the glass. I heard it go crash in the dark. I
shoved along till I was opposite the medallion section of the
case—luckily some one made way for me just then—and I got to work with
my lead pipe. The glass smashed easily—it must have been cracked
before. So I put my hand in and groped about. I could find only three
medallions instead of six; but I hooked them out, slabbed on some
plasticine, stuck them under the case for future reference, and cut my
stick for the door. Some one was ahead of me there, and I heard some
sort of mix-up in the dark. Then I wandered out into the garden by the
east door, as soon as I could find it in the dark. And I’ve been out
there having a smoke till now. When I came in again, I heard you’d
been asking for me, so I came along.”

Sir Clinton considered for a moment.

“I want to be quite clear on one point,” he said with no relaxation of
his manner. “You say that you heard the glass crack before you began
your work. Are you certain of that?”

“Quite,” said Foxy.

“And when you got your hand into the case you could find only three
medallions?”

“That was all. I was groping for the top row of the six; and naturally
it surprised me when I felt only three altogether. I’m quite certain
about it.”

“So you were evidently the second thief at the case to-night?” Sir
Clinton concluded.

Foxy flushed at the word “thief” but a glance at the face of the Chief
Constable evidently persuaded him that it would be best not to argue
on philology at that moment. He contented himself with nodding
sullenly in response to Sir Clinton’s remark.

Joan relieved the tension.

“Anyhow, we’ve got the medallions safe, and that’s all that really
matters,” she pointed out. “Let’s have a look at them, Cecil.”

She took them from his hand and scrutinized them carefully.

“Yes, these are the real Leonardos,” she affirmed, without hesitation.
“That’s all right.”

“Quite all right,” admitted Sir Clinton, with a wry smile, “except for
one point: Why were the replicas stolen and the real things left
untouched?”

“That certainly seems to need explaining,” Una admitted. “Can you
throw any light on it, Foxy? You’re the only one of us who was near
the case.”

There was no hint of accusation in her tone; but Foxy seemed to read
an insinuation into her remark.

“I haven’t got the replicas, if that’s what you mean, Una,” he
protested angrily. “I just took what was left—and it turns out to be
the real things. Whoever was ahead of me took the duds.”

Cecil considered the point, and then appealed to Sir Clinton.

“Doesn’t that seem to show that an outsider’s been at work—some one
who knew a certain amount about the collection, but not quite enough?
An outsider wouldn’t know we had the replicas in the case alongside
the real things. He’d just grab three medallions and think he’d got
away with it.”

Sir Clinton shook his head.

“Your hypothetical outsider, Cecil, must have had a preliminary look
at the case before the lights went out—just to make sure of getting to
the right spot in the dark. Therefore he must have seen the six
medallions there; and he’d have taken the lot instead of only three,
when he had his chance.”

“That upsets your applecart, Cecil,” said Joan. “It’s obvious Sir
Clinton’s right. Unless”—a fresh idea seemed to strike her—“unless the
thief knew of the replicas and had wrong information, so that he
imagined he was taking the Leonardos when he really was grabbing the
replicas. I mean he may have thought that the replicas were in the top
row instead of the lower one.”

She glanced at Sir Clinton’s face to see what he thought of her
suggestion; but he betrayed nothing.

“Wouldn’t you have taken the whole six, Joan, if you had been in his
shoes?”

Joan had to admit that she would have made certain by snatching the
complete set.

“There’s more in it than that,” was all that Sir Clinton could be
induced to say.

Before any more could be said, the door opened again. This time it was
Michael Clifton who entered the museum.

“You’ve got him, Michael?” cried Joan. “Who was he?”

Michael shook his head.

“He got away from us. It’s a damned mysterious business how he managed
it; but he slipped through our fingers, Joan.”

“Well, tell us what happened—quick!” Joan ordered. “I didn’t think
you’d botch it, Michael.”

Michael obeyed her at once and launched into an account of the
moonlight chase of the fugitive. Sir Clinton listened attentively, but
interposed no questions until Michael had finished his story.

“Let’s have this quite clear,” the Chief Constable said, when the tale
had been completed. “You had him hemmed in at the cliff top; you heard
a splash, but there was no sign of any one swimming in the lake; you
discovered a rope tied to the balustrade and lying down the cliff-face
to the cave-mouth; he wasn’t in the cave when you looked for him
there. Is that correct?”

“That’s how it happened.”

“You’re sure he didn’t break back through your cordon?”

“Certain.”

“And you found Maurice in one of the Fairy Houses in the spinney?”

“Yes. He seemed in a queer state.”

Sir Clinton, glancing at Cecil’s face, was surprised to see on it the
same expression of almost malicious glee which he had surprised on the
day when they examined that very Fairy House during their walk. Quite
obviously Cecil knew something more than the Chief Constable did.

“Does that suggest anything to you, Cecil?” he demanded point-blank.

At the query, Cecil’s face came back to normal suddenly.

“To me? No, why should it?”

“I merely wondered,” said Sir Clinton, without seeming to notice
anything.

It was clear that whatever Cecil knew, it was something which he was
not prepared to tell.

Foxy had listened intently to Michael’s narrative, and as the Chief
Constable seemed to have come to the end of his interrogations, Foxy
put a question of his own.

“You say Maurice was wearing a white Pierrot costume? So was the
fellow you were chasing. So was the man next me at the case when the
lights went out.”

“I suppose you’re suggesting that Maurice is at the bottom of the
business, Foxy,” Michael replied at once. “I’ll swallow that if you’ll
answer one question. Why should a man burgle his own house?”

“Lord alone knows,” Foxy admitted humbly. “I’ve no brain-wave on the
subject.”

“It seems rather improbable,” observed Sir Clinton. “I think you’ll
have to produce a motive before that idea could be accepted.”

He glanced round at the door as he spoke and added:

“Here’s Maurice himself.”

Maurice Chacewater had entered the room while the Chief Constable was
speaking. He had discarded his fancy costume and wore ordinary
evening-dress, against the black of which his face looked white and
drawn. He came up to the group and leaned on the show-case as if for
support.

“So you’ve muddled it, Michael,” he commented, after a pause. “You
didn’t get your hands on the fellow, after all?”

Dismissing Michael with almost open contempt, he turned to Sir
Clinton.

“What’s the damage? Did the fellow get away with anything of value?”

“Nothing much: only your three replicas of the Leonardo medallions, so
far as we can see.”

As he spoke, his glance telegraphed a warning to the rest of the
group. It seemed unnecessary that Maurice should know all the ins and
outs of the night’s doings.

But Foxy evidently failed to grasp the meaning of the Chief
Constable’s look.

“We saved the real medallions for you, Maurice. Vote of thanks to us,
eh?”

“How did you manage that?” Maurice demanded, with no sign of gratitude
in his voice.

Quite oblivious of the warning looks thrown at him by the rest of the
group, Foxy launched at once into a detailed account of the whole
practical joke and its sequel. Maurice listened frowningly to the
story. When it was completed, he made no direct comment.

“Who’s got the medallions? You, Joan? I’ll take them.”

When she had handed them over, he scrutinized them carefully.

“These seem to be the Leonardo ones,” he confirmed.

Sir Clinton interposed a question.

“Were the medallions and the replicas in their usual places to-night,
Maurice? I mean, were the real things in the top row and the electros
down below?”

Maurice gave a curt nod of assent. He weighed the three medallions
unconsciously in his hand for a moment, then moved over to the safe in
the wall of the museum.

“These things will be safer under lock and key, now,” he said.

He opened the safe, inserted the medallions, closed the safe-door with
a clang, and busied himself with the combination of the lock.

Before saying anything further, Sir Clinton waited until Maurice had
returned to the group.

“There’s one thing,” he said. “I shall have to look into this affair
officially now. It’s essential that things shall be left as they are.
Especially the place where that fellow gave you the slip, Clifton.
Nobody must be wandering about there, up at the spinney, until I’ve
done with the ground. There may be clues left, for all one can tell;
and we can’t run the risk of their being destroyed.”

Maurice looked up gloomily.

“Very well. I’ll give orders to the keepers to patrol the wood and
turn every one back. That do?”

“So long as no one sets foot on anything beyond the wood, I’ll be
quite satisfied. But it’s important, Maurice. Impress that on your
keepers, please.”

Maurice indicated his comprehension with a nod.

“I’ll begin dragging the lakelet up there to-morrow morning,” Sir
Clinton added. “Something must have gone into the water to make the
splash that was heard; and perhaps we shall find it. I don’t mind any
one going down by the lake side. It’s the top of the cliff that I want
kept intact.”

He looked at his watch.

“You’re on the ’phone here? I must ring up the police in Hincheldene
now and make arrangements for to-morrow. Show me your ’phone, please,
Joan. And as I must get some sleep to-night, I’ll say good-bye to the
rest of you now. Come along, Ariel. Lead the way.”



CHAPTER VII

What Was in the Lake

“I was afraid of it,” Sir Clinton observed, as he lifted the dripping
pole with which he had been sounding the water of the lakelet. “The
net will be no good, Inspector. With these spikes of rock jutting up
from the bottom all over the place, you couldn’t get a clean sweep;
and if there’s anything here at all, it’s pretty sure to have lodged
in one of the cavities between the spikes.”

It was the morning after the masked ball at Ravensthorpe. The Chief
Constable had made all his arrangements overnight, so that when he
reached the shore of the artificial lake, everything was in readiness.
The decrepit raft had been strengthened; a large net had been brought
for the purpose of dragging the pool; and several grapnels had been
procured, in case the net turned out to be useless. Sir Clinton had
gone out on the raft to sound the water and discover whether the net
could be utilized; but the results had not been encouraging.

Inspector Armadale listened to the verdict with a rather gloomy face.

“It’s a pity,” he commented regretfully. “Dragging with the grapnel is
a kind of hit-or-miss job, Sir Clinton; and it’ll take far longer than
working with the net.”

Sir Clinton acquiesced with a gesture.

“We’d better start close in under the cliff-face,” he said. “If
anything came down from the top, it can’t have gone far before it
sank. One of the people last night was watching the pool and he saw
nothing on the surface after the splash, so it ought to be somewhere
near the cave-mouth. You can pole over to the shore now, Constable;
we’ve done with this part of the business.”

The constable obeyed the order and soon Sir Clinton rejoined the
Inspector on the bank.

“It’s likely to be a troublesome business,” the Chief Constable
admitted as his subordinate came up. “The bottom’s very irregular and
the chances are that the grapnel will stick, two times out of three.
However, the sooner we get to work, the better.”

He considered for a moment or two.

“Tack a light line to the grapnel as well as the rope. Get the raft
out past the cave and let a constable pitch the grapnel in there. Then
when you’ve dragged, or if the grapnel sticks, he can pull the hook
back again with the light line and start afresh alongside the place
where he made the last cast. But it’s likely to be a slow business, as
you say.”

The Inspector agreed and set his constables to work at once. Sir
Clinton withdrew to a little distance, sat down on a small hillock
from which he could oversee the dragging operations, and patiently
awaited the start of the search. His eyes, wandering with apparent
incuriosity over the group at the water’s edge, noted with approval
that Armadale was wasting no time.

Having made his instructions clear, the Inspector came over to where
the Chief Constable was posted.

“Sit down, Inspector,” Sir Clinton invited. “This may take all day,
you know, and it’s as cheap sitting as standing.”

When the Inspector had seated himself, the Chief Constable turned to
him with a question.

“You’ve seen to it that no one has gone up on to the terrace?”

Inspector Armadale nodded affirmatively.

“No one’s been up on top,” he explained, “I’d like to go and have a
look round myself; but since you were so clear about it, I haven’t
gone.”

“Don’t go,” Sir Clinton reiterated his order. “I’ve a sound reason for
letting no one up there.”

He glanced for a moment at the group of constables.

“Another thing, Inspector,” he continued. “There’s no secrecy about
that matter. In fact, it might be useful if you’d let it leak out to
the public that no one has been up above there and that no one will be
allowed to go until I give the word. Spread it round, you understand?”

Slightly mystified, apparently, the Inspector acquiesced.

“Do you see your way through the case, Sir Clinton?” he demanded.
“You’ve given me the facts, but we’ll need a good deal more, it seems
to me.”

Sir Clinton pulled out his cigarette-case and thoughtfully began to
smoke before answering the question. When he spoke again, his reply
was an indirect one.

“There’s an old jurist’s saying that I always keep in mind,” he said.
“It helps to clarify one’s ideas in a case:

    Quis, quid, ubi, quibus auxiliis, cur, quomodo, quando?

That puts our whole business into a nutshell.” He glanced at the
Inspector’s face. “Your Latin’s as feeble as my own, perhaps? There’s
an English equivalent:

    What was the crime, who did it, when was it done, and where,
    How done, and with what motive, who in the deed did share?

How many of these questions can you answer now, offhand, Inspector?
The rest of them will tell you what you’ve still got to ferret out.”

Inspector Armadale pulled out a notebook and pencil.

“Would you mind repeating it, Sir Clinton? I’d see through it better
if I had it down in black and white.”

The Chief Constable repeated the doggerel and Armadale jotted it down
under his dictation.

“That seems fairly searching,” he admitted, re-reading it as he spoke.

“Quite enough for present purposes. Now, Inspector, how much do you
really know? I mean, how many answers can you give? There are only
seven questions in all. Take them one by one and let’s hear your
answers.”

“It’s a pretty stiff catechism,” said the Inspector, looking again at
his notebook. “I’ll have a try, though, if you give me time to think
over it.”

Sir Clinton smiled at the qualification.

“Think it over, then, Inspector,” he said. “I’ll just go and set them
to work with the dragging. They seem to be ready to make a start.”

He rose and walked down to the group at the edge of the pool.

“You know what’s wanted?” he asked. “Well, suppose we make a start.
Get the raft out to about ten yards or so beyond the cave-mouth and
begin by flinging the grapnel in as near the cliff-edge as you can.
Then work gradually outwards. If it sticks, try again very slightly
off the line of the last cast.”

He watched one or two attempts which gave no result and then turned
back to the hillock again.

“Well, Inspector?” he demanded as he sat down and turned his eyes on
the group engaged with the dragging operations. “What do you make of
it?”

Inspector Armadale looked up from his notebook.

“That’s a sound little rhyme,” he admitted. “It lets you see what you
don’t know and what you do know.”

Sir Clinton suppressed a smile successfully.

“Or what you think you know, perhaps, Inspector?”

“Well, if you like to put it that way, sir. But some things I think
one can be sure of.”

Sir Clinton’s face showed nothing of his views on this question.

“Let’s begin at the beginning,” he suggested. “‘What was the crime?’”

“That’s clear enough,” the Inspector affirmed without hesitation.
“These three electrotypes have been stolen. That’s the crime.”

Sir Clinton seemed to be engrossed in the dragging which was going on
methodically below them.

“You think so?” he said at length. “H’m! I’m not so sure.”

Inspector Armadale corrected himself.

“I meant that I’d charge the man with stealing the replicas. You
couldn’t charge him with anything else, since nothing else is missing.
At least, that’s what you told me. He wanted the real medallions, but
he didn’t pull that off.”

Sir Clinton refused to be drawn. He resorted to one of his indirect
replies.

“‘What was the crime?’” he repeated. “Now, I’ll put a case to you,
Inspector. Suppose that you saw two men in the distance and that you
could make out that one of them was struggling and the second man was
beating him on the head. What crime would you call that? Assault and
battery?”

“I suppose so,” Armadale admitted.

“But suppose, further, that when you reached them, you found the
victim dead of his injuries, what would you call the crime then?”

“Murder, I suppose.”

“So your view of the crime would depend upon the stage at which you
witnessed it, eh? That’s just my position in this Ravensthorpe affair.
You’ve been looking at it from yesterday’s standpoint, and you call it
a theft of three replicas. But I wonder what you’ll call it when we
know the whole of the facts.”

The Inspector declined to follow his chief to this extent.

“All the evidence we’ve got, so far, points to theft, sir. I’ve no
fresh data that would let me put a new name to it.”

“Then you regard it as a completed crime which has partly failed in
its object?”

The Inspector gave his acquiescence with a nod.

“You think it’s something else, Sir Clinton?” he inquired.

The Chief Constable refused to be explicit.

“You’ve got all the evidence, Inspector. Do you really think a gang
would take the trouble to steal replicas when they could just as
easily have taken the three originals—that’s the point. The replicas
have no intrinsic value beyond the gold in them, and that can’t be
worth more than twenty or thirty pounds at the very outside. A
mediocre haul for a smart gang, isn’t it? Hardly Trade Union wages, I
should think.”

“It seems queer at first sight, sir,” he admitted, “but I think I can
account for that all right when you come to the rest of your rhyme.”

Sir Clinton showed his interest.

“Then let’s go on,” he suggested. “The next question is: ‘Who did it?’
What’s your answer to that, Inspector?”

“To my mind, there seems to be only one possible thief.”

Sir Clinton pricked up his ears.

“You mean it was a single-handed job? Who was the man, then?”

“Foxton Polegate,” asserted the Inspector.

He watched Sir Clinton’s face narrowly as he brought out the name, but
the Chief Constable might have been wearing a mask for all the change
there was in his features as he listened to the Inspector’s
suggestion. As if he felt that he had overstepped the bounds of
prudence, Armadale added hastily:

“I said ‘possible thief,’ sir. I don’t claim to be able to bring it
home to him yet.”

“But you think it might even be ‘probable’ instead of only ‘possible,’
Inspector? Let’s hear the evidence, please.”

Inspector Armadale turned over the leaves of his notebook until he
reached some entries which he had previously made.

“First of all, sir, Polegate must have known the value of these
medallions—the originals, I mean. Second, he learned that they would
be on show last night; and he knew where they’d be placed in the
museum. Third, it was after Polegate came by this knowledge that the
practical joke was planned. Fourth, who suggested the sham burglary?
Polegate. Then fifth, who gave himself the job of actually taking the
medallions? Polegate again. Sixth, where was Polegate immediately
after the robbery? We’ve only his own word for it that he was
strolling about, having a smoke. He might have been elsewhere, easily
enough. Seventh, he was dressed up as a Harlequin when you saw him:
but he might quite easily have slipped on a white jacket and a pair of
Pierrot’s trousers over his Harlequin costume. He could disguise
himself as a Pierrot in a couple of ticks and come out as a Harlequin
again just as quick. So he might quite well have been the man in white
that they were all busy chasing last night. Eighth, he knows the
ground thoroughly and could give strangers the slip easily enough at
the end of the chase. And, ninth, he didn’t appear when you wanted him
last night. He only turned up when he’d had plenty of time to get home
again, even if he’d been the man in white. That’s a set of nine points
that need looking into. _Prima facie_, there’s a case for suspicion,
if there’s no more. And there isn’t anything like so strong a case
against any one else, Sir Clinton.”

“Well, let’s take the rest of the first line,” said the Chief
Constable, without offering any criticism of the Inspector’s statement
of the case. “‘When was it done, and where?’”

“At 11.45 p.m. and in the museum,” retorted Armadale. “That’s beyond
dispute. It’s the clearest thing in the whole evidence.”

“I should be inclined to put it at 11.44 p.m. at the latest, or
perhaps 11.43 p.m.,” said Sir Clinton, with an air of fastidiousness.

The Inspector looked at him suspiciously, evidently feeling that he
was being laughed at for his display of accuracy.

“I go by Miss Rainhill’s evidence,” he declared. “She was the only one
who had her eye on her watch, and she said she pulled out the switch
at 11.45 precisely.”

“I go by the evidence of Polegate and young Chacewater,” said Sir
Clinton, with a faint parody of the Inspector’s manner. “They were
taken by surprise when the light went out, although they expected it
to be extinguished at 11.45 p.m.”

“Oh, have it your own way, sir, if you lay any stress on the point,”
conceded the Inspector. “Make it 11.44 or 11.45; it’s all the same, so
far as I’m concerned.”

Armadale seemed slightly ruffled by his chief’s method of approaching
the subject. Sir Clinton turned to another side of the matter.

“I suppose you say the crime has been committed in the museum?” he
inquired.

The Inspector looked at him suspiciously.

“You’re trying to pull my leg, sir. Of course, it was committed in the
museum.”

Sir Clinton’s tone became apologetic.

“I keep forgetting that we’re not talking about the same thing,
perhaps. Of course, the theft of the replicas was committed in the
museum. We’re quite in agreement there.”

He threw away his cigarette, selected a fresh one, and lighted it
before continuing.

“And on that basis, I suppose there’s no mystery about the next query
in the rhyme: ‘How done?’”

“None whatever, in my mind,” the Inspector affirmed. “Polegate could
take what he wanted, once the light was out.”

Sir Clinton did not dispute this point.

“Of course,” he said. “And now for the next query: ‘With what motive?’
Where do you stand in that matter, Inspector?”

But here Armadale evidently felt himself on sure ground.

“Polegate’s a rackety young fool, sir. This is where local knowledge
comes in. He’s got no common sense—always playing practical jokes.
He’s been steadily muddling away the money his father left him. I
shouldn’t be surprised if he’s hard up. That’s the motive.”

“And you think he’d steal from his oldest friends?”

“Every man has his price,” retorted the Inspector, bluntly. “Put on
the screw hard enough in the way of temptation, and any man’ll fall
for it.”

“Rather a hard saying that, Inspector; and perhaps a trifle too
sweeping.” Sir Clinton turned on Armadale suddenly. “What would be
_your_ price, now, if I asked you to hush up this case against young
Polegate? Put a figure on it, will you?”

Armadale flushed angrily at the suggestion; then, seeing that he had
been trapped, he laughed awkwardly.

“Nobody knows even their own price till it’s put on the table, Sir
Clinton,” he countered, with a certain acuteness.

The Chief Constable turned away from the subject.

“You’re depending on there being a fair chance of Polegate getting
away with the medallions without being suspected. But when young
Chacewater and Miss Rainhill were in the scheme as well as Polegate,
suspicion was sure to light on him when the medallions vanished. The
other two were certain to tell what they knew about the business.”

Inspector Armadale glanced once more at his notebook in order to
refresh his memory of the rhyme.

“That really comes under the final head: ‘Who in the deed did share?’”
he pointed out.

“Pass along to the next caravan, then, if you wish,” Sir Clinton
suggested. “What animals have you in the final cage?”

The Inspector seemed to deprecate his flippancy.

“It’s been very cleverly done,” he said, seriously. “You objected that
suspicion was bound to fall on young Polegate; and so it would have
done, if he hadn’t covered his tracks so neatly. He’s set every one on
the hunt for a gang at work, or at least for an outside criminal. Now
I believe it was a one-man show from the start, worked from the
inside. Polegate planned the practical joke—that gave him his chance.
Then he forced himself forward as the fellow who was to do the actual
stealing—and that let him get his hands on the medallions while young
Chacewater held the keeper up for him. Without the hold-up of the
keeper, the thing was a wash-out. The joke helped young Polegate to
enlist innocent assistance.”

“But still suspicion would attach to him,” Sir Clinton objected.

“Yes, except for a false trail,” the Inspector agreed. “But he laid a
false trail. Instead of waiting for the switch to be pulled out, he
fired his shot from the bay, extinguished the light and then rushed
out of the bay and went for the medallions.”

“Well?” said Sir Clinton in an encouraging tone.

“When he’d smashed the glass of the case, he took out the whole six
medallions, and not merely three of them as he told you he’d done.”

“And then?”

“He pocketed the replicas and stuck the real things under the case
with plasticine. Then he continued the false trail by bolting out of
the house. He was the man in white. When he got clear of the people
who were chasing him, he came back to the house again, ready to play
his part as an innocent practical joker. And he had his tale ready, of
how some one was beside him at the case, wearing a Pierrot costume.
That stamped the notion of an outside gang on everybody’s mind. Both
sets of medallions had gone. He—the innocent practical joker—could
have produced the replicas from his pocket and sworn they were all
that the gang had left in the case by the time he got to it.”

“And . . . ?”

“And then, a few days later, he’d have managed to get into the museum
on some excuse—he’s a friend of the family—and he’d have had no
difficulty in taking the real medallions from under the case where
he’d left them. He’d have to take the chance that they’d been
overlooked. The false trail would help in that. He’d hardly expect a
close search of the museum after the man in white had got clear away.
And by running the business on these lines, he’d avoid any chance of
being caught with the stuff actually in his pocket at any time.”

“But in that case, why did he hand over the real things to me like a
lamb as soon as I challenged him?”

The Inspector was ready for this.

“Because as soon as he came into the museum last night, he found that
you apparently knew everything—or a good deal more than he’d counted
on. Anyhow, he didn’t know how much you knew; and he felt he’d got
into a tight corner. He just let the whole thing slide and made up his
mind to get out before things got too hot. So he pretended that so far
as he was concerned, the practical joke was the thing; and he gave up
the real medallions and kept the replicas in his pocket.”

“Why? He might as well have given up the lot.”

“No,” the Inspector contradicted. “He’d got to keep the false trail
going, for otherwise there would have been awkward questions as to why
he diverged from the prearranged programme. I mean the shooting out of
the light, the lies about the man in white, and so forth. So he stuck
to the replicas and made out that there was an outsider mixed up in
the affair. But thanks to the practical joke, the outsider had missed
the real stuff; and Polegate was really the saviour of the Leonardo
set.”

Sir Clinton seemed to be pondering over Armadale’s version of the
affair. At last he gave his own view.

“A jury wouldn’t look at that evidence,” he pointed out.

“I don’t suppose they would,” Armadale admitted. “But there may be
more to come yet.”

“I expect so,” Sir Clinton agreed.

He rose as he spoke, and, followed by the Inspector, went down to the
edge of the lakelet.

“No luck yet?” he inquired.

“None, sir. It’s a very difficult bottom to work a grapnel over. It
sticks three times out of four.”

Sir Clinton watched the line of the drag which they were making.

“It’ll take a while to cover the ground at this rate,” he commented,
noting the smallness of the area they had searched up to that moment.

As he turned away from the water-side, he noticed Cecil Chacewater
approaching round the edge of the lakelet, and leaving the Inspector
to superintend the dragging, he walked over to meet the newcomer. As
he came near, he could see that Cecil’s face was sullen and downcast.

“’Morning, Sir Clinton. I heard you were here, so I came across to say
good-bye before I clear out.”

Sir Clinton could hardly pretend astonishment in view of what he knew
about the state of affairs at Ravensthorpe; but he did not conceal his
regret at the news.

“There was a row-royal between Maurice and me this morning,” Cecil
explained, gloomily. “Of course this medallion business gave him his
chance, and he jumped in with both feet, you know. He abused me like a
fish-wife and finally gave me permission to do anything except stay at
Ravensthorpe after to-night. So I’m off.”

“I wish you hadn’t got mixed up with that silly practical joke,” Sir
Clinton said in some concern. “I can’t forgive that young blighter for
luring you into it.”

Cecil’s resentment against his brother was evidently too deep to let
him look on the matter from this point of view.

“If it hadn’t been that, it would have been something else. Any excuse
would have served his turn, you know. He’d have flung me out sooner or
later—probably sooner. I’ve felt for long enough that he was itching
to clear me off the premises. Foxy’s little show only precipitated
things. The root of the trouble was there long before.”

“Well, it’s a sad business.” Sir Clinton saw that it was useless to
dwell on the subject. “You’re going up to town? Any address you can
give me?”

“I’ll probably put up with a man for a day or two. He’s been inviting
me to his place once or twice lately, but I’ve never been able to fit
it in; so I may as well take him at his word now. I’ve got to look
round for something to do, you know.”

“If you want some one to speak for you, Cecil, refer them to me when
you apply for anything. And, by the way, if you happen to run short,
you know my address. A letter will always find me.”

Cecil thanked him rather awkwardly.

“I hope it won’t come to that,” he wound up. “Something may turn up
sooner than one hopes.”

Sir Clinton thought it well to change the subject again.

“By the way, Cecil,” he asked, “do you know anything about this man
Foss? What sort of person is he?”

It seemed an unfortunate topic. Cecil’s manner was anything but
gracious as he replied:

“Foss? Oh, you know what sort of a fellow he is already. A damned
eavesdropper on his hosts and a beggar with a tongue hinged in the
middle so that he can talk with both ends at once. I’d like to wring
his neck for him! What do they call the breed that runs off and splits
to the police? Copper’s narks, isn’t it?”

“It wasn’t exactly that side of him that I wanted to hear about,
Cecil. I’m quite fully acquainted with his informative temperament
already. What I want to know is the sort of man he is socially and so
forth.”

Cecil curbed his vexation with an effort.

“Oh, he seems to have decent enough manners—a bit Yankee, perhaps, in
some things. He must do well enough out of this agent business of his,
acting for Kessock and the like, you know. He arrived here with a big
car, a chauffeur, and a man. Except for his infernal tale-bearing, I
can’t say he’s anything out of the ordinary.”

Sir Clinton, apparently feeling that he had struck the wrong vein in
the conversational strata, contented himself with a nod of
comprehension and let Cecil choose his own subject for the next stage
in their talk. He was somewhat surprised when it came.

“Have you heard the latest from the village?” Cecil demanded.

Sir Clinton shook his head.

“I’ve had very little time to collect local gossip this morning,
Cecil. I’ve been busy getting things started for this bit of work in
the lake, you see.”

“If you’d been down in Hincheldene village you could hardly have
missed it. I went down this morning to get some tobacco and I found
the whole place buzzing with it. That was before I’d seen Maurice,
luckily.”

“Suppose you tell me what it is,” Sir Clinton suggested, drily.

“Do you remember my telling you about the family spectre, the White
Man?” Cecil asked. “Well, it seems that the village drunkard, old
Groby, was taking a short cut through our woods last night—or rather
this morning, for he’s a bit of a late going-to-rooster—and he got the
shock of his life in one of the glades. He swears he saw the White Man
stealing about from tree to tree. By his way of it, he was near enough
to see the thing clearly—all white, even the face. What a lark!”

“You certainly seem to take your family spectre a bit lightly, Cecil.
What’s the cream of the jest?”

Cecil’s face took on a vindictive expression.

“Oh, it gave me a chance of getting home on Maurice, after he’d given
me the key of the street. I told him all about it and I rubbed in the
old story. You know what I mean? The White Man never appears except
when the head of the family’s on his last legs. Maurice didn’t like it
a bit. He looked a bit squeamish over it; and I came away leaving that
sticking in his gills.”

Sir Clinton hardly concealed his distaste for this kind of thing.

“You flatter yourself, I expect. Maurice is hardly likely to waste any
thought over superstitions of that sort.”

Cecil’s expression still showed a tinge of malice.

“You’d wonder,” he said. “It’s all very well for you to sneer at these
affairs; but it looks a bit different when you yourself happen to be
the object of them, I guess. It’s easy to say ‘Superstition’ in a
high-minded way; but if there’s one per cent. chance that the
superstition’s going to hit you personally, then, you know, it rankles
a bit. Anything to give pain is my motto where Maurice is concerned.”

Quite oblivious of Sir Clinton’s rather disgusted expression, he
laughed softly to himself for a moment or two.

“And the funniest thing in the whole affair,” he went on, “is that I
know all about this White Man. Can’t you guess what it was?”

Sir Clinton shook his head.

“Why, don’t you see?” Cecil demanded, still laughing. “What old Groby
came across must obviously have been Maurice himself in his white
Pierrot dress, coming back from the burglar-hunt! That’s what makes it
so damned funny. Fancy Maurice getting the creeps on account of
himself! It’s as good a joke as I’ve heard for a while.”

He laughed harshly.

“You don’t seem to see it. Well, well. Perhaps you’re right. And now I
must be getting back to the house. I’ve a lot of stuff to collect
before I go off.”

He shook hands with Sir Clinton and moved off towards Ravensthorpe.
The Chief Constable gazed after him for a moment or two.

“That young man’s in a most unpleasant frame of mind,” he commented to
himself. “He’s obviously quite off his normal balance when he’d make a
point of that kind of thing. I can’t say I take much stock in
brotherly love; but this is really overdoing the business. Both of
them seem to have taken leave of ordinary feelings. It’s just as well
they’re parting, perhaps.”

Rather moodily he retraced his steps to where the Inspector was
directing the operations by the bank of the lakelet; but by the time
he reached the group his face had taken on its normal expression.

“Fishing still poor?” he demanded, as he came up.

“Nothing so far, sir,” the Inspector confessed. “These rocks are the
very deuce to work amongst. I’ve been running the grapnel over the
same track two or three times, just in case we miss the thing the
first shot. We’ve had no luck at all—unless you count this as a
valuable find: a bit of limestone or something like that.”

He kicked a shapeless mass of white stone as he spoke. Sir Clinton
stooped over it: a dripping mass about the size of a man’s fist. The
Inspector watched him as he examined it; but Sir Clinton’s face
suggested neither interest nor satisfaction.

“Might be a bit of marble that got swept over the top when they were
putting up the balustrade in the old days,” the Inspector hazarded.

Sir Clinton looked at it again and shook his head.

“I doubt it,” he said. “However, since it’s the only thing you’ve
fished up, you’d better keep it, Inspector. One never knows what may
be useful. I might make a paper-weight out of it as a souvenir.”

The Inspector failed to see the point of the joke, but he laughed as
politely as he could.

“Very well, Sir Clinton, I’ll see that it’s put aside.”

He glanced over the Chief Constable’s shoulder.

“Here’s Mr. Clifton coming, sir.”

Sir Clinton turned round to find that Michael Clifton had approached
while he was engaged with the dragging operations. Leaving the group
by the bank, he walked slowly to meet the advancing figure.

“Good morning, Mr. Clifton. Come up to see how we’re getting on, I
suppose. There’s nothing to report, I’m afraid.”

“Drawn blank?” Michael inquired, needlessly. “There ought to be
something there, all the same.”

“It may have been only a stone,” Sir Clinton pointed out. “You heard a
splash; that’s all we have to go on. And a stone would make that as
well as anything else.”

“That’s true,” Michael admitted. “None of us saw the thing hit the
water, so we’ve no notion what it was like. It might have been a stone
for all we can tell. But why should the fellow pitch a brick into the
water? That’s what puzzles me.”

Before Sir Clinton could reply, a shout came from the bank, and the
Inspector waved to them to come down.

“We’ve got something, sir,” he called, as they drew nearer.

Followed by Michael, Sir Clinton hurried up to the group at the
water’s edge. The Inspector was kneeling down, carefully disentangling
the grapnel from something white. At last he rose and held out his
capture. Michael gave an exclamation.

“A white jacket!”

A little further shaking of the material showed that it was a complete
white Pierrot costume, except for the cap and shoes. The Inspector
spread it out on the grass to dry, after holding the jacket outspread
in the air so that they could gauge its size by comparison with his
own body.

“That’s what I’ve been hoping to get hold of, Inspector,” Sir Clinton
said. “I doubt if you’ll find much more in the pool. But perhaps you’d
better go on dragging for a while yet. Something else might turn up.”

He examined the costume carefully; but it was quite evident that there
were no identifying marks on it. During the inspection, Michael showed
signs of impatience; and as soon as he could he unostentatiously drew
Sir Clinton away from the group.

“Come up here, Mr. Clifton,” the Chief Constable suggested, as he
turned towards the hillock he had chosen earlier in the morning. “We
can keep an eye on things from this place.”

He sat down and Michael, after a glance to see that they were out of
earshot of the dragging party, followed his example.

“What do you make of that?” he demanded eagerly.

Sir Clinton seemed to have little desire to discuss the matter.

“Let’s be quite clear on one point before we begin,” he reminded
Michael. “I’m a Chief Constable, not a broadcasting station. My
business is to collect information, not to throw it abroad before the
proper time comes. You understand?”

Rather dashed, Michael admitted the justice of this.

“I’m a public servant, Mr. Clifton,” Sir Clinton pointed out, his
manner taking the edge off the directness of his remarks, “and I get
my information officially. Obviously it wouldn’t be playing the game
if I scattered that information around before the public service has
had the use of it.”

“I see that well enough,” Michael protested. “All I asked was what
your own views are.”

Sir Clinton smiled and there was a touch of mischief in his eye as he
replied.

“Seeing that my conclusions are based on the evidence—at least I like
to think so, you know—they’re obviously part and parcel of my official
knowledge. Hence I don’t divulge them till the right moment comes.”

He paused to let this sink in, then added lightly:

“That’s a most useful principle, I find. One often makes mistakes, and
of course one never divulges them either, until the right time comes.
It’s curious, but I’ve never been able yet to satisfy myself that the
right time has come in any case of the sort.”

Michael smiled in his turn; and Sir Clinton went on:

“But there’s no reason why you shouldn’t draw your own conclusions and
give me the benefit of them. I’m not too proud to be helped, you
know.”

For a moment Michael kept silence, as if considering what his next
move should be. Sir Clinton had given him what might have looked like
a snub; but Michael had acuteness enough to tell him that the matter
was one of principle with the Chief Constable and not merely a pretext
devised on the spur of the moment to suppress inconvenient curiosity.

“It just occurred to me,” he confessed, “that there’s a possible
explanation of that thing they’ve fished up. Do you remember that I
found Maurice in the Fairy House up above there”—he indicated the
cliff-top with a gesture—“and when I left him there he was still
wearing a white costume like this one?”

“So you told us last night,” Sir Clinton confirmed.

“Now when Maurice turned up in the museum later on,” Michael
continued, “he was wearing ordinary evening clothes. He’d got rid of
the Pierrot dress in the meantime.”

“That’s true,” Sir Clinton agreed.

“Isn’t it possible,” Michael went on, “that after I left him, Maurice
got over his troubles, whatever they were, and pitched his disguise
over the edge here. This may quite well be it.”

“Rather a rum proceeding, surely,” was Sir Clinton’s comment. “Can you
suggest any earthly reason why he should do a thing like that?”

“I can’t,” Michael admitted, frankly. “But the whole affair last night
seemed to have neither rhyme nor reason in it; and after swallowing
the escape of that beggar we were after, I’m almost prepared for
anything in this neighbourhood. I just put the matter before you. I
can’t fake up any likely explanation to account for it.”

Sir Clinton seemed to be reflecting before he spoke again.

“To tell you the truth, I was rather disappointed with the result of
that drag. Quite obviously—this isn’t official information, for you
can see it with your own eyes—quite obviously that Pierrot costume
must have been wrapped round some weight or other, or it wouldn’t have
sunk to the bottom. And in the dragging the weight fell out. I could
make a guess at what the weight was; but I wish we’d fished it up. It
doesn’t matter much, really; but one likes to get everything one can.”

Michael, unable to guess what lay behind this, kept silent in the hope
that there was more to come; but the Chief Constable swung off to a
fresh subject.

“Did you take a careful note of the costumes of the gang who helped
you in the attempt to round the beggar up? Could you make a list of
them if it became necessary?”

Michael considered for the best part of a minute before answering.

“Some of them I could remember easily enough; but not all, I’m sure.
It was a bit confused, you know; and some of the crew turned up pretty
late, when all my attention was focused on the final round-up. I
really couldn’t guarantee to give you an accurate list.”

Sir Clinton’s nod indicated approval.

“That’s what I like,” he said. “I’d rather have a definite No than a
faked-up list that might mean nothing at all. But there’s one point
that’s really important. Did you notice, among your assistants,
anybody in white like the man you were hunting?”

Michael apparently had no need to pause before replying.

“No,” he said definitely, “I saw nobody of that sort. I suppose you
mean Maurice. He certainly wasn’t in the cordon when it went into the
spinney or when it came out on the terrace. I’m absolutely sure of my
ground there. But of course he may have been one of the late-comers.
Almost as soon as we got to the terrace we had to sprint off down to
the lake side, you see; and he might quite well have been a bit slow
in the chase and have reached the top only after we’d come down here.”

“That’s all I wanted to know,” said Sir Clinton, with a finality which
prevented any angling for further information.

Michael evidently had no desire to outstay his welcome, for in a few
minutes he rose to his feet.

“I think I’ll go over to Ravensthorpe now,” he said. “I suppose you’re
not going to leave here for a while?”

The words recalled to Sir Clinton the fact that he had not yet
congratulated Michael on his engagement. He hastened to repair the
oversight.

“I was looking for you at the dance last night,” he explained, after
Michael had thanked him, “but before I got hold of you, this burglary
business cropped up, and I’ve had hardly a minute to spare since then.
By the way, if you’re going over to the house, you might tell Joan
that I shall probably have to pay them a visit shortly, but I’ll ring
up and let them know when I’m coming.”

Michael nodded and turned away, skirting the lakelet on his way to
Ravensthorpe. Sir Clinton sauntered over to the waterside and watched
the dragging operations which were still going on. When he made his
way back to the hillock again, Inspector Armadale followed him.

“There’s another point that occurred to me, sir,” he explained. “I
think you told me that Polegate was wearing a Harlequin’s costume last
night?”

“That’s correct,” Sir Clinton confirmed. “And what then?”

“One difficulty I’ve had,” the Inspector went on, “was to explain how
the fellow in white got away from them all so neatly. I think I see
now how it was done.”

Sir Clinton made no effort to conceal his interest.

“Yes, Inspector?”

Armadale obviously took this as complimentary.

“This is how I figure it out, sir. Polegate had a white jacket and
Pierrot trousers on over his Harlequin costume. At the end of the
chase he bolted into the spinney and out on to the terrace above here.
That gave him a breathing-space. It took Mr. Clifton a minute or two
to organize his cordon; and during that time the thief was hidden from
them by the trees.”

“That’s obviously true,” Sir Clinton admitted. “If he did change his
costume, it must have been at that moment.”

“I expect he had a weight of some sort ready on the terrace,” the
Inspector continued. “When he’d stripped off his jacket and trousers,
he wrapped them round the weight and pitched them over into the pool.
That would make the splash they all heard.”

“And after that?”

The Inspector was evidently delighted with his idea.

“That leaves us with Polegate in Harlequin dress on the terrace, with
a minute or two to spare before the cordon was ready to move forward
into the spinney.”

“Admitted.”

“Do you remember the camouflaged ships in the War, Sir Clinton?”

“I sailed in one, if that’s what you mean.”

“Well, you know what they were like: all sorts of cock-eyed streaks
and colours mixed up in a regular tangle to destroy their real
outlines. And what’s a Harlequin’s costume? Isn’t it the very same
thing?”

Sir Clinton confirmed this with an historical allusion.

“You’re quite correct, Inspector. As a matter of fact, the Harlequin’s
dress was originally designed to represent Invisibility. Nobody except
Columbine was supposed to be able to see Harlequin, you know.”

Inspector Armadale hurried to his conclusion.

“What was to hinder Polegate, during that breathing-space, getting
back into the spinney? It was a moonlight night. You know what the
spinney would be like under a full moon: it would be all dappled with
spots of moonlight coming through the trees. And against a setting of
that sort the Harlequin costume would be next door to invisible. He’d
only have to stand still in some chequered spot and no one would
detect him. They were all hunting for a man dressed in white. None of
them noticed him. None of them saw him, I guess.”

Much to the Inspector’s surprise, Sir Clinton shook his head.

“I’d be prepared to bet pretty heavily that someone saw him,” he
affirmed.

The Inspector looked at his Chief for a moment, obviously taken aback.

“You think some one saw him?”

Then a flood of light from a fresh angle in his mind seemed to
illuminate the question.

“You mean he had a confederate in the cordon? Some one who let him
through and kept it dark? I never thought of that! You had me beaten
there, Sir Clinton. And of course, now I see it, that’s the simplest
solution of the whole affair. If we can get a list of the people in
the cordon, we’ll be able to pick out the confederate before long.”

Sir Clinton damped his enthusiasm slightly.

“It won’t be so easy to get that list, Inspector. Remember the
confusion of the whole business: the hurry, the effect of moonlight,
the masks, the costumes, and all the rest of it. You may be able to
put a list together; but you’ll have some difficulty yourself in
believing that you’ve tracked down every possible person who was in
the line. And if you miss one . . .”

“He may be the man, you mean? Well, there’s no harm in trying. I’ll
turn a sergeant on to gather all the news he can get.”

“It’ll be a good test of his capacity, then, even if nothing else
comes out of it,” Sir Clinton certified, carelessly.



CHAPTER VIII

The Murder in the Museum

Sir Clinton cut short the shrill ringing of his desk telephone by
picking up the receiver.

“The Chief Constable speaking,” he informed his inquirer.

Michael Clifton’s voice sounded over the wire.

“Can you come up to Ravensthorpe at once, Sir Clinton, or send
Inspector Armadale? There’s a bad business here. Mr. Foss has been
murdered. I’ve taken care that no one has got off the premises; and
I’ve seen to it that his body has been left as it was found.”

Sir Clinton glanced at his wrist-watch.

“I’ll drive across as soon as possible. See that things are left
undisturbed, please. And collect all the people who can give any
evidence, so that we needn’t waste time hunting for them. Good-bye.”

He shifted the switch of his telephone and spoke again.

“Is Inspector Armadale here just now?” he asked the constable who
answered his call. “Tell him I wish to see him in my room
immediately.”

While waiting for Armadale, Sir Clinton had a few moments in which to
consider the information he had just received.

“This looks like Part II of the Ravensthorpe affair,” he reflected.
“Foss’s only connection with Ravensthorpe was the business of these
Medusa Medallions. First one has the theft of the replicas; now comes
the murder of this American agent. It’s highly improbable that two
things like that could be completely independent.”

His cogitation was interrupted by the entry of Armadale, and in a few
words Sir Clinton gave him the fresh information which had come to
hand.

“We’ll go up there at once in my car, Inspector. Get the necessary
things together, please. Don’t forget the big camera. We may need it.
And the constable who does photography for us had better come along
also.”

Inspector Armadale wasted no time. In a very few minutes they were on
the road. As he drove, Sir Clinton was silent; and Armadale’s attempt
to extract further information from him was a complete failure.

“You know as much as I do, Inspector,” the Chief Constable pointed
out. “Let’s keep clear of any preconceived ideas until we see how the
land lies up yonder.”

When they reached Ravensthorpe, they found Michael Clifton waiting for
them at the door.

“There are only two people who seem to know anything definite about
things,” he replied to the Chief Constable’s first inquiry. “Joan’s
one of them, but she really knows nothing to speak of. The other
witness is Foss’s man—Marden’s his name. Will you have a look at the
body first of all, and then see Joan and this fellow?”

Sir Clinton nodded his acquiescence and the party followed Michael to
the museum. Mold, the keeper, was again on guard at the door of the
room, and Sir Clinton made a gesture of recognition as he passed in,
followed by Armadale.

A cursory glance showed Foss’s body lying in one of the bays formed by
the show-cases round the wall. The Inspector went forward, knelt down,
and held a pocket-mirror to the dead man’s lips.

“Quite dead, sir,” he reported after a short time.

“The police surgeon will be here shortly,” Sir Clinton intimated. “If
he’s dead, we can postpone the examination of the body for a short
time. Everything’s to be left as it is until we come back. Turn the
constable on to photograph the body’s position in case we need it,
though I don’t think we shall. Now where’s Miss Chacewater? We’d
better get her version of the affair first. Then we can question the
valet.”

Without being acutely sensitive to atmosphere, Michael Clifton could
not help noticing a fresh characteristic which had come into the Chief
Constable’s manner. This was not the Sir Clinton with whom he was
acquainted: the old friend of the Chacewater family, with his faintly
whimsical outlook on things. Instead, Michael was now confronted by
the head of the police in the district, engaged in a piece of official
work and carrying it through in a methodical fashion, as though
nothing mattered but the end in view.

Followed by the two officials, Michael led the way to the room where
Joan was waiting. The Chief Constable wasted no time in unnecessary
talk. In fact, he plunged straight into business in a manner which
suggested more than a touch of callousness. Only later on did Michael
realize that in this, perhaps, Sir Clinton displayed more tact than
was apparent at the moment. By his manner, he suggested that a murder
was merely an event like any other—rather uncommon, perhaps, but not a
thing which called for any particular excitement; and this almost
indifferent attitude tended to relax Joan’s overstrained nerves.

“You didn’t see the crime actually committed, of course?”

Joan shook her head.

“Shall I begin at the beginning?” she asked.

Sir Clinton, by a gesture, invited her to sit down. He took a chair
himself and pulled out a notebook. Inspector Armadale copied him in
this. Michael remained standing near Joan’s chair, as though to lend
her his moral support.

After thinking for a moment or two, Joan began her story.

“Some time after lunch, I was sitting on the terrace with Mr. Foss. I
forget what we were talking about—nothing of any importance. Soon
after that, Maurice came out of the house and sat down. I was
surprised to see him, for he’d arranged to play golf this afternoon.
But he’d sprained his right wrist badly after lunch, it seems, and had
’phoned to put off his match. He sat nursing his wrist, and we began
to speak of one thing and another. Then, I remember, Mr. Foss somehow
turned the talk on to some of the things we have. It was mostly about
Japanese things that they spoke; and Mr. Foss seemed chiefly
interested in some of the weapons my father had collected. I remember
they talked about a Sukesada sword we have and about the Muramasa
short sword. Mr. Foss said that he would like to see them some time.
He thought that Mr. Kessock would be interested to hear about them.”

She broke off and seemed to be trying to remember the transitions of
the conversation. Sir Clinton waited patiently; but at last she
evidently found herself unable to recall any details of the next stage
in the talk.

“I can’t remember how it came up. It was just general talk about
things in our collection and things Mr. Foss had seen elsewhere, but
finally they got on to the Medusa Medallions somehow. Mr. Foss was
telling Maurice how tantalizing it was to buy these things and pass
them on to collectors when he’d like to keep them for himself if only
he could afford it. Then it came out that he always took a rubbing of
all the coins and medals he came across. I remember he made some
little joke about his ‘poor man’s collection’ or something like that.
I forget exactly how it came about, but either he asked Maurice to let
him have another look at the Leonardo medallions or Maurice
volunteered to let him take rubbings there and then. I can’t recall
the exact way in which the suggestion was made. I wasn’t paying much
attention at the time.”

She looked up to see if Sir Clinton showed any sign of annoyance at
incomplete information; but his face betrayed neither dissatisfaction
nor approval. Inspector Armadale, though following the evidence keenly
and making frequent notes, seemed to think that very little of her
information was to the point.

“Then,” Joan went on, “I remember Mr. Foss getting up from his chair
and saying: ‘If you’ll wait a moment, I’ll get the things.’ And he
went away and left Maurice and me together. I said: ‘What’s he gone
for?’ And Maurice said: ‘Some paper to take rubbings of the medallions
and some stuff he uses for that, dubbin or something.’ In a few
minutes, Mr. Foss came back again with some sheets of paper and some
black stuff in his hand. I was interested in seeing how he did his
rubbing or whatever you call it, so I went with them to the museum.”

“And then?” Sir Clinton prompted. As they were evidently coming near
the moment of the murder in Joan’s narrative, it was clear that he
wished to leave her no time to think of the crime itself.

“We went into the museum. Since that night of the masked ball, Maurice
has removed most of the smaller articles of value from the cases and
put them into the safe; so in order to get the medallions he had to
open the safe. It’s a combination lock, you know; and as I knew
Maurice wouldn’t like us to be at his elbow while he was setting the
combination, I took Mr. Foss under my wing and led him over to where
the Sukesada sword is hung on the wall. We looked at it for a few
moments. I remember taking it out of its sheath to show the blade to
Mr. Foss. Then I heard Maurice slamming the door of the safe; and when
we went into the bay where it is, Maurice was there with the Leonardo
medallions in his hand.”

“One moment,” Sir Clinton interrupted. “You said it was a combination
lock on the safe. Do you happen to know the combination?”

Joan shook her head.

“Maurice is the only one who knows that. He never told it to any of
us.”

Sir Clinton invited her to continue.

“Maurice handed Mr. Foss one of the medallions and Mr. Foss took it
over to the big central case—the one with the flat top. Then he began
to take a rubbing of the medallion with his paper and black stuff. He
didn’t seem quite satisfied with his first attempt, so he had a second
try at it. As we were watching him, he seemed to prick up his ears,
and then he said: ‘There’s some one calling for you, Miss Chacewater.’
I couldn’t hear anything myself; but he explained that the voice was
pretty far off. He had extra good hearing, I remember he said. He
seemed very positive about it, so I went off to see what it was all
about.”

“Was that the last time you saw him?”

“Yes,” said Joan, but she had obviously more to tell.

“And then?”

“As I was going away from the museum door, I met Mr. Foss’s man,
Marden. He had a small brown-paper parcel in his hand. He stopped me
and asked me if I knew where Mr. Foss was. Something about the parcel,
I gathered, though I didn’t stop to listen to him. I told him Mr. Foss
was in the museum; and I went on to see if I could find who was
calling. I searched about and came across Mr. Clifton; but I didn’t
hear any one calling my name. Mr. Foss must have been mistaken.”

“And then?”

Michael Clifton evidently thought it unnecessary that Joan should bear
the whole burden of giving evidence. At this point he broke in.

“Miss Chacewater and I were together in the winter-garden when I heard
a shout of ‘Murder!’ I didn’t recognize the voice at the time. I left
Miss Chacewater where she was and made my way as quick as I could
towards the voice. It came from the museum, so I hurried there. I
found Foss on the floor with a dagger of some sort in his chest. He
was gone, so far as I could see, before I came on the scene at all.
The man Marden was in the room, tying up his hand. It was bleeding
badly and he said he’d cut it on the glass of a case. I kept him under
my eye till I could get a couple of keepers; and then I rang you up at
the station.”

“What had become of Mr. Chacewater?” Sir Clinton asked, without
showing that he attached more than a casual interest to the question.

“That’s the puzzle,” Michael admitted. “I didn’t see him anywhere in
the museum at the moment and I’ve been hunting for him everywhere
since then: but he’s not turned up. He may have gone out into the
grounds, of course, and left Foss alone in the museum; and possibly he
had got out of earshot before the cry of ‘Murder!’ was raised by the
valet. I don’t know.”

Sir Clinton saw that the Inspector wished to ask a question, but he
silenced him by a glance.

“One more point, and we’re done, I think,” he said, turning to Joan.
“Can you give me a rough idea of the time when the cry of ‘Murder!’
was raised? I mean, how long was it after you had left the museum
yourself?”

Joan thought for a few seconds.

“It took me three or four minutes before I came across Mr. Clifton,
and we were together—how long would you say, Michael?—before we heard
the shout?”

“Not more than five minutes,” Michael suggested.

“That’s about it,” Joan confirmed. “That would make it about eight or
nine minutes, roughly, between the time I left the museum and the time
we heard the shout.”

“About that,” Michael agreed.

Sir Clinton rose and closed his notebook.

“That’s all you have to tell us? Everything that bears on the matter,
so far as you know?”

Joan paused for a moment or two before replying.

“That’s all that I can remember,” she said at last, after an evident
effort to recall any fresh details. “I can’t think of anything else
that would be of use.”

“You’ve no idea where your brother is?”

“None at all,” Joan answered. Then a thought seemed to strike her.
“You don’t think Maurice had anything to do with this?” she demanded,
anxiously.

“He’ll turn up shortly to speak for himself, I’ve no doubt,” Sir
Clinton said, as though to reassure her. “Now that’s all we need just
now, so far as you’re concerned. I’m going to take Mr. Clifton away
for a few minutes, but he’ll be back again almost immediately.”

With a reassuring smile, the Chief Constable excused himself and led
the way to the door, followed by Michael and the Inspector. As soon as
he was out of the room, he turned to Michael.

“You’re quite sure that Mr. Chacewater wasn’t in the museum when you
reached it?”

Michael considered carefully before replying.

“I don’t see how he could have been. I glanced into all the bays; and
you know there isn’t cover enough for a cat in the place.”

“Was the safe door open or shut, did you notice?”

Michael again reflected before replying.

“Shut, I’m almost certain.”

Sir Clinton in his turn seemed to reflect for a moment or two.

“We’ll have a look at this fellow Marden, now, I think, Inspector, if
you’ll bring him along to the museum. We’d better hear his tale on the
spot. It’ll save explanations about the positions of things.”

Inspector Armadale departed on his quest while Michael and the Chief
Constable made their way to the scene of the crime. Suddenly Sir
Clinton turned and confronted Michael.

“Have you any notion whatever as to where Maurice has gone? I want the
truth.”

Michael was manifestly taken aback by the direct demand.

“I haven’t a notion,” he declared. “He wasn’t in the museum when I got
there, so far as I know. You can put me on my oath over that, if you
like.”

The Chief Constable scanned his face keenly, but made no comment on
his statement. He led the way to the museum; and they had hardly
passed through the door before Inspector Armadale returned with the
valet.

Marden appeared to be a man of about thirty years of age. Sir Clinton
noticed that he carried himself well and did not seem to have lost his
head in the excitement of the past hour. When he spoke, it was without
any appreciable accent; and he seemed to take pains to be perfectly
clear in his evidence. Sir Clinton, by an almost imperceptible
gesture, handed over the examination of the valet to the Inspector.
Armadale pulled out his notebook once more.

“What’s your name?” he demanded.

“Thomas Marden.”

“How long have you been in Mr. Foss’s service?”

“Since he arrived here from America, about three months ago.”

“How did he come to engage you?”

“Advertisement.”

“You knew nothing about him before that?”

“Nothing.”

“Where was he living then?”

“At 474a Gunner’s Mansions, S.W. It’s a service flat.”

“He still has that flat?”

“Yes.”

“How did he spend his time?”

The valet seemed astonished by the question.

“I don’t know. None of my business.”

Inspector Armadale was not to be turned aside.

“You must have known whether he stayed in the flat or went out
regularly at fixed times.”

Marden seemed to see what was wanted.

“You mean, did he go out to an office every day? No, he came and went
just when it suited him.”

“Had he much correspondence?”

“Letters? Just about what one might expect.”

The Inspector looked up gloomily. So far, he had not got much to go
upon.

“What do you mean by: ‘Just what one might expect?’”

“He got some letters every day, sometimes one or two, sometimes half a
dozen. Just what one might expect.”

“Have you any idea whether they were business letters or merely
private correspondence?”

Marden seemed annoyed by the question.

“How should I know?” he demanded, stiffly. “It’s not my business to
pry into my employer’s affairs.”

“It’s your business to read the addresses on the envelopes to see that
the postman hasn’t left wrong letters. Did you notice nothing when you
did that? Were the addresses mainly typewritten or written by hand?”

“He got bills and advertisements with the address typewritten—like
most of us. And one or two letters came addressed by hand.”

“Did you notice the stamps?”

“Some were American, of course.”

“So it comes to this,” Inspector Armadale concluded, “he was not
carrying on a big business from the flat; most of his letters were
ordinary bills and so forth; but he had some private correspondence as
well; and part of his correspondence was with America? Why couldn’t
you tell us that straight off, instead of having it dragged out of
you?”

The valet was quite unruffled by the Inspector’s tone.

“I hadn’t put two and two together the way you do. They were just
letters to me. I didn’t think anything about them.”

Inspector Armadale showed no appreciation of this indirect tribute to
his powers.

“Had he many visitors?”

“Not at the flat. He may have met his friends in the restaurant
downstairs for all I know.”

“Do you remember any visitors at the flat?”

“No.”

The Inspector seemed to recollect something he had missed.

“Did he get any telegrams?”

“Yes.”

“Frequently?”

“Fairly often.”

“You’ve no idea of the contents of these wires?”

Marden obviously took offence at this.

“You asked me before if I pried into his affairs; and I told you I
didn’t.”

“How often did these wires arrive?” the Inspector demanded, taking no
notice of Marden’s annoyance.

“Perhaps once or twice a week.”

“Did he bet?” the Inspector inquired, as though it had just struck him
that the telegrams might thus be explained.

“I know nothing about that.”

Armadale went off on a fresh tack.

“Did he seem to be well off for money?”

“He paid me regularly, if that’s what you mean.”

“He had a car and a chauffeur, hadn’t he?”

“Yes.”

“Were they his own or simply hired?”

“I don’t know. Not my business.”

“The Gunner’s Mansions flats are expensive?”

“They get the name of it. I don’t know what he paid.”

“You don’t seem to have had much curiosity, Marden.”

“I’m not paid for being curious.”

The Inspector put down his pencil and reflected for a moment or two.

“Have you any idea of his address in America?”

“Not my business.”

“Did he write many letters?”

“I couldn’t say. None of my business.”

“You can at least say whether he gave you any to post.”

“He didn’t.”

“Have you anything else you can tell us about him?”

Marden seemed to think carefully before he replied.

“All his clothes were split new.”

“Anything else?”

“He carried a revolver—I mean an automatic.”

“What size was it?”

“About that length.”

The valet indicated the length approximately with his hands, and
winced slightly as he moved the bandaged one.

“H’m! A .38 or a .45,” Armadale commented. “Too big for a .22,
anyway.”

He took up his pencil again.

“Now come to this afternoon. Begin at lunchtime and go on.”

Marden reflected for a moment, as though testing his memory.

“I’d better begin before lunch. Mr. Foss came to me with a parcel in
his hand and asked me to take it over to Hincheldene post office. He
wanted it registered. He offered to let me take the car if I wished;
but I preferred to walk over. I like the fresh air.”

“And then?” demanded the Inspector with an unconscious plagiarism of
his Chief.

“Immediately after lunch, I set out and walked through the grounds
towards Hincheldene village. I didn’t hurry. It was a nice afternoon
for a walk. By and by I met a keeper, and he told me I couldn’t go any
farther in that direction. He’d orders to turn back any one, he said.
I talked to him for a minute or two, and explained where I was going;
and I pulled the parcel out of my pocket as a guarantee of good faith.
He didn’t know me, you see. And when I got the parcel out, I noticed
the label quite by chance.”

“Ah, you do look at addresses after all!” interjected the Inspector.

“Quite by chance,” Marden went on, without taking any notice of the
thrust. “And I saw that Mr. Foss had made a mistake.”

“How did you know that,” Inspector Armadale demanded, with the air of
a cat pouncing on a mouse. “You said you’d taken no interest in his
correspondence and yet you knew this parcel was directed to a wrong
address. Curious, isn’t it?”

Marden did not even permit himself to smile as he discomfited the
Inspector.

“He’d left out the name of the town. An obvious oversight when he was
writing the label.”

“Well, go on,” growled the Inspector, evidently displeased at losing
his score.

“As soon as I saw that, I knew it was no good taking the thing to the
post office as it was. So I asked the keeper a question or two about
the shortest way to Hincheldene without getting on to the barred
ground. Then I turned and came home again, intending to ask Mr. Foss
to complete the address on the parcel.”

“What time was it when you reached here again?”

Marden considered for a while.

“I couldn’t say precisely. Sometime round about half-past three or a
bit later. I didn’t look at the time.”

“What did you do then?”

“I hunted about for Mr. Foss, but he didn’t seem to be in the house.
At last, when I was just giving it up, I met Miss Chacewater coming
away from this room, and she told me that Mr. Foss was inside. She
went away, and I came to the door. It was half-open and I could hear
voices inside: Mr. Foss and Mr. Chacewater from the sound. I thought
they’d soon be coming out and that I’d get Mr. Foss as he passed me;
so I waited, instead of interrupting them.”

“How long did you wait?”

“Only a minute or two, so far as I can remember.”

“You could hear them talking?”

“I could hear the sound of their voices. I couldn’t hear what they
said. There’s an echo or something in this room and all I heard was
the tone they were speaking in.”

“What sort of tone do you mean?”

Marden paused as though searching for an adjective.

“It seemed to me an angry tone. They raised their voices.”

“As if they were quarrelling?”

“Like that. And then I heard Mr. Chacewater say: ‘So that’s what
you’re after?’ Then I heard what sounded like a scuffle and a gasp. I
was taken aback, of course. Who wouldn’t be? I stood stock still with
the parcel in my hand for a moment or two. Then I got my head back and
I pushed open the door and rushed into the room.”

“Be careful here,” Sir Clinton interrupted. “Don’t try to force your
memory. Tell us exactly what comes back into your mind.”

Marden nodded.

“When I got into the room here,” he went on, “the first thing I saw
was Mr. Chacewater. He had his back to me and was just turning the
corner here.”

Marden walked across and indicated the end of the bay beyond the one
which contained the safe, the last recess in the room at the end
opposite from the door.

“He went round this corner in a hurry. That’s the last I saw of him.”

Marden’s face betrayed his amazement even at the recollection.

“Never mind that just now,” said Sir Clinton. “Tell us what you did
yourself.”

“I couldn’t see Mr. Foss at the first glance; but when I got near the
corner where I’d seen Mr. Chacewater, I saw Mr. Foss lying on the
floor. I thought he’d slipped or something; and I went over to give
him a hand up. Then I saw a big knife or a dagger through his chest
and some blood on his mouth. As I was hurrying over to his side, I
slipped on the parquet—it’s very slippery—and down I came. I put out
my hand to save myself and my fist broke the glass in one of these
cases. When I got up again, my hand was streaming with blood. It’s a
nasty gash. So I pulled out my handkerchief and wrapped it around my
hand before I did anything else. It was simply gushing with blood and
I thought of it first of all.”

Marden held up his roughly swathed hand in proof.

“I got to my feet again and went over to Mr. Foss. By that time he was
either dead or next door to it. He didn’t move. I didn’t touch him,
for I saw well enough he was done for. Then I went to the door and
shouted ‘Murder!’ as hard as I could. Then while I was shouting, it
struck me as queer that Mr. Chacewater had disappeared.”

“It didn’t occur to you that he might have slipped out of the room
while your back was turned—when you were busy over Mr. Foss?” demanded
Inspector Armadale in a hostile tone.

Marden shook his head.

“It didn’t occur to me at all, because I knew it hadn’t happened. No
one could have got out of the room without my seeing him.”

“Go on with your story, please,” Sir Clinton requested.

“There’s nothing more to tell. I kept shouting ‘Murder!’ and I
searched the room here while I was doing it. I found nothing.”

“Was the safe door closed when you saw it first?” Sir Clinton
inquired.

“Yes, it was. I thought perhaps Mr. Chacewater might be inside, with
the door pulled to; so I tried the handle. It was locked.”

Sir Clinton put a further inquiry.

“You heard only two voices in the room before you burst in?”

A new light seemed to be thrown by this question across Marden’s mind.

“I heard only two people speaking: Mr. Foss and Mr. Chacewater; but of
course I couldn’t swear that only two people were in the room. That’s
what you meant, isn’t it?”

Inspector Armadale caught the drift of the inquiry.

“I suppose if one man can disappear in a mysterious way, there’s
nothing against two men vanishing in the same way,” he hazarded. “So
all you can really tell us is that Mr. Foss and Mr. Chacewater were
here at any rate, and possibly there were other people as well?”

“I couldn’t swear to any one except these two,” Marden was careful to
state.

“Another point,” Sir Clinton went on. “Have you any idea whether Mr.
Foss came into contact with a person or persons outside the house
during his stay here? I mean people known to him before he came to
Ravensthorpe?”

“I couldn’t say.”

“None of your business, I suppose?” Inspector Armadale put in, with an
obvious sneer.

“None of my business, as you say,” Marden returned, equably. “I wasn’t
engaged as a detective.”

“Well, this question falls into your department,” Sir Clinton
intervened, as Armadale showed signs of losing his temper. “What
costume was Mr. Foss wearing on the night of the masked ball? You must
know that.”

Marden replied without hesitation.

“He was got up as a cow-puncher. He hired the costume from London when
he heard about the fancy dress. It was a pair of cow-boy trousers, big
heavy things with fringes on them; a leather belt with a
pistol-holster on it; a coloured shirt; a neck-cloth; and a flappy
cow-boy hat.”

“Rather a clumsy rig-out, then?”

Marden seemed to find difficulty in repressing a smile.

“It was as much as he could do to walk at all, until he got accustomed
to the things. He told me it gave him a good excuse for not dancing.
He wasn’t a dancing man, he said.”

“He carried a revolver, you say. Did you ever see any sign that he was
afraid of anything of this sort happening to him?”

“I don’t understand. How could I know what he was afraid of or what he
wasn’t? It was none of my business.”

Sir Clinton’s smile took the edge off Marden’s reply.

“Oh, I think one might make a guess,” he said, “if one kept one’s eyes
open. A terrified man would give himself away somehow or other.”

“Then either he wasn’t afraid or else I don’t keep my eyes open. I saw
nothing of the sort.”

Sir Clinton reflected for a moment or two. He glanced at Armadale.

“Any more questions you’d like to put? No? Then that will do, Marden.
Of course there’ll be an inquest and your evidence will be required at
it. You can stay on here until you’re needed. I’ll see Miss Chacewater
about it. But for the present you’ve given us all the help you can?”

“Unless you’ve any more questions you want to ask,” Marden suggested.

Sir Clinton shook his head.

“No, I think I’ve got all I need for the present, thanks. I may want
you again later on, of course.”

Marden waited for nothing further, but left the room pursued by a
slightly vindictive glance from Inspector Armadale. When he had
disappeared, Sir Clinton turned to Michael Clifton.

“Hadn’t you better go back to Joan, now? She must be rather nervous
after this shock.”

Michael came to himself with a slight start when the Chief Constable
addressed him. Hitherto his rôle had been purely that of a spectator;
and he had been so wrapped up in it that it came as a faint surprise
to find himself directly addressed. Throughout the proceedings he had
been semi-hypnotized by the deadly matter-of-fact way in which the
police were going about their work. When he had first heard of the
murder, he had felt as though something unheard-of had invaded
Ravensthorpe. Of course murders did take place: one read about them in
the newspapers. But the idea that murder could actually be done in his
own familiar environment had come to him with more than a slight
shock. The normal course of things seemed suddenly diverted.

But during the last ten minutes he had been a witness of the beginning
of the police investigation; and the invincible impression of
ordinariness had begun to replace the earlier nightmare quality in his
mind. Here were a couple of men going about the business as though it
were of no more tragic character than a search for a lost dog. It was
part of their work to hunt out a solution of the affair. They were no
more excited over it than a chess-player looking for the key-move in a
problem. The cool, dispassionate way in which the Chief Constable had
handled the affair seemed to strike a fresh note and to efface the
suggestions of the macabre side of things which had been Michael’s
first impression of the matter. The Dance of Death retreated gradually
into the background in the face of all the minute questionings about
letters, and visits, and parcels—these commonplace things of everyday
life.

“If I can be of no use here,” he said, “I think I’d better go.”

He hesitated for a moment as a fresh thought struck him.

“By the way, how much of this is confidential?”

Sir Clinton looked at him with an expressionless face.

“I think I may leave that to your discretion. It’s not for
broadcasting, at any rate.”

“What about Maurice?” Michael persisted.

“I’d leave Maurice out of it as far as possible,” said Sir Clinton, in
obvious dismissal. “Now, Inspector, I think we’d better have a look at
the late Mr. Foss.”

Michael retreated from the room as they turned towards the body on the
floor.

“Leave Maurice out of it!” he thought, as he walked at a snail’s pace
towards the room where he had left Joan. “That’s a nice bit of advice!
If you leave Maurice out of it, there seems to be nothing left in it.
Now what the devil am I to say to her? If I say nothing, she’ll jump
to the worst conclusion; and if I say anything at all, she’ll jump to
the same.”



CHAPTER IX

The Muramasa Sword

As the door closed behind Michael Clifton, the Chief Constable turned
to the Inspector.

“Now we can get to business, Inspector. Let’s have a look round the
place at leisure, and perhaps the surgeon will turn up before we reach
the body itself.”

Followed by Armadale, he stepped over to the bay containing the corpse
of Foss and began methodically to inspect the surroundings.

“This must have been the case that Marden slipped against when he cut
his hand,” the Inspector pointed out. “There’s a big hole in the glass
and some blood on the broken edges of the gap.”

“Oh, yes, there’s blood enough to suit most people,” Sir Clinton
admitted, with a glance towards the shattered case. But he seemed less
interested in the glass than in the floor surface; for he moved slowly
to and fro, evidently trying to place himself so that the sunlight
from the window was reflected up to him from the parquet. After a
moment or two, he seemed satisfied.

“That part of Marden’s story seems true enough. He did slip here. If
you come across, you’ll see a line where the polish of the parquet has
been taken off by some hard part of his shoe. You won’t be able to
spot it unless you make a mirror of the floor.”

The Inspector in his turn moved over and satisfied himself of the
existence of the faint mark.

“That confirms part of his story,” he admitted, grudgingly. “There’s a
lot of blood about, quite apart from the stuff from the body. One
might make something out of that.”

“Suppose we try,” Sir Clinton suggested. “Assume that he cut his hand
here on the glass. He’d be all asprawl on the floor; and the first
thing he’d do would be to put his hands down to help himself up. That
would account for these biggish patches here, under the case. Then a
foot or so away you see those round marks of droplets with tiny
splashes radiating from them with a fair regularity all round. These
must have been made by drops falling from his hand while he stood
still—no doubt while he was feeling with the other hand for his
handkerchief to stanch the bleeding.”

The Inspector indicated his agreement.

“After he’d got it fixed up, one might expect him to go over and look
at Foss. He’d gone down on the floor, you remember, while he was
hurrying to Foss’s assistance.”

“There’s no sign of that,” Armadale hastened to point out. “I can’t
see any blood-drops round about the body.”

“Oh, don’t be in too much of a hurry, Inspector. Perhaps they fell in
the pool of Foss’s own blood or, more probably, his handkerchief
soaked up any blood that flowed just then.”

Sir Clinton, still with his eyes on the ground, began to cast about in
search of further traces.

“Ah, here are a couple of drops at the end of the bay. Have a look at
them, Inspector.”

Armadale knelt down and examined the clots.

“Made on his way to the door, probably,” he suggested.

“They might have been, if he was swinging his arms as one does when
one walks freely; but one doesn’t usually swing the arm when there’s a
fresh wound in the hand, I think. These aren’t round blobs like the
others; they’re elongated, and all the splashing from them is at one
end—the end towards the safe. His hand, when they were made, was
moving towards the safe’s bay, whatever his body was doing.”

Sir Clinton made a rough measurement of the distance between the two
drops.

“If they’d been nearer together or further apart, then each of them
might have been made while his arm was going backwards in its natural
swing while he was walking towards the door. But the distance between
them won’t fit that. You’ll see at once if you try walking over the
ground yourself, Inspector; for you’re just about Marden’s height and
your stride must be nearly the same as his.”

“He said something about going to the safe and trying the handle,” the
Inspector admitted, grudgingly. “So far, his tale’s got some support.”

Sir Clinton smiled covertly at Armadale’s obvious desire to pick holes
in the valet’s narrative.

“Well, let’s find out how it happened,” Sir Clinton suggested. “He
evidently passed this bay and went on towards the next one, where the
safe is. We’ll follow his example.”

They turned the corner of the show-case and stepped over to the safe
door.

“There’s a trace of blood on the handle, true enough,” the Inspector
admitted. “But I’m not sure he told the truth about why he came to the
safe.”

Sir Clinton inspected the smear of blood on the handle, but he seemed
to attach very little importance to it.

“I suppose one mustn’t jump to conclusions and assume that
everything’s all above-board,” he conceded. “But even if we keep open
minds, wouldn’t it be the most natural thing in the world for Marden
to try the safe door? Remember what had happened according to his
story. Mr. Chacewater was in the room, for Marden saw him with his own
eyes. Mr. Chacewater turned the corner of a bay—the one next this; and
then Marden lost him for good. If you’d been in Marden’s place,
wouldn’t you have searched about, and then, finding no trace of the
missing man, wouldn’t you have jumped to the conclusion that he might
be hidden in the safe? And wouldn’t you have given the handle a pull,
just to make sure the safe was really locked and that Mr. Chacewater
wasn’t hiding inside it?”

“I suppose so,” conceded the Inspector, evidently dissatisfied.

“I expect his tale isn’t complete, of course. He could hardly give
every detail. It would be a bit suspicious if he had, I think. If his
tale had been absolutely complete in every detail, I’d be inclined to
suspect a previously prepared recitation rather than an account of the
facts. In a case of this sort, one could hardly expect a water-tight
narrative, could one?”

He continued his examination of the floor; but there seemed to be no
other blood-stains of any importance.

“Now let’s have a glance at the body,” he suggested. “We needn’t shift
it till the surgeon comes; but we can see what’s to be seen without
altering its position in the meanwhile.”

The Inspector was the first to reach the spot, and as he knelt down
beside the corpse he gave an exclamation of surprise.

“Here’s an automatic pistol, sir. It’s lying almost under the body,
but I can see the muzzle. It looks like a .38 calibre.”

“Leave it there. We’ll get at it later.”

Sir Clinton examined the body itself. The cause of death seemed
obvious enough, for the weapon still remained in the wound. A glance
at it set the Chief Constable’s eye ranging over the museum cases. He
retreated from the bay and searched for a time until he found what he
was looking for: an empty sheath in an unlocked case. Without touching
the sheath, he scanned the Japanese inscription on its surface.

“So that’s the thing?”

The Inspector had come across to his side and stood looking at the
sheath.

“So the thing’s one of the specimens?” he asked.

“Yes. Don’t touch it, Inspector. We may as well see whose
finger-prints are on it, though it’s quite on the cards that it’s been
handled by other people lately as well as the murderer. It’s rather a
show specimen, you see—one of Muramasa’s making. This was the sword
they were discussing when they were out on the terrace. Muramasa’s
weapons have the name of being unlucky; and this one seems to bear out
the legend.”

The Inspector looked at the sheath with apparent care, but his
thoughts seemed to be elsewhere.

“Nobody could have got away from here through the windows,” he
observed, rather irrelevantly. “They’re all barred outside, and the
catches are fast on the sashes.”

Evidently Sir Clinton had noticed this in the course of his previous
search, for he gave a tacit assent to the Inspector’s statement
without even glancing up at the windows.

“Here are the sheets of rubbing-paper that Foss was using,” the
Inspector went on, picking them up as he spoke. “They’ll have his
finger-prints on them, so I’ll stow them away. We might need them. One
never knows.”

“We can get actual prints from the body if we need them,” Sir Clinton
pointed out. “You don’t suppose it’s a suicide case, do you?”

The Inspector was too wary to throw himself open to attack. He
contented himself with putting the papers away carefully in his
pocket-book.

“Finger-prints will be useful, though,” Sir Clinton went on. “At the
earliest possible moment, Inspector, I want you to get prints from the
fingers of every one in the house. Start with Miss Chacewater. She’ll
agree to let you take hers without any trouble; and after that you can
go on to Mr. Clifton and so down the scale. We’ve no authority for
insisting, of course; but you can make a note if any one objects. I
expect you’ll get the lot without difficulty.”

At this moment Mold opened the door to admit the police surgeon; and
Sir Clinton broke off in order to explain the state of affairs to him.
Dr. Greenlaw was a business-like person who wasted no time. While Sir
Clinton was speaking, he knelt down beside the corpse and made a
cursory examination of it. When he rose to his feet again, he seemed
satisfied.

“That sword appears to have entered the thorax between the fifth and
sixth ribs,” he pointed out. “It’s pierced the left lung, evidently;
you notice the blood-foam on his lips? And most probably it’s
penetrated right into the heart as well. It looks as if it had; but of
course I’ll need to carry out a P.M. before I can give you exact
details.”

“I suppose we can take out the sword before we shift the body?” asked
the Inspector. “We want to examine it before any one else touches it.”

“Certainly,” Greenlaw replied. “You can see for yourselves what
happened. He was struck from the front by a right-handed man—a fairly
heavy blow, I should judge from the depth to which that sword has
buried itself. There’s no sign of a twist in the wound, which looks as
though he went down under it at once. Quite possibly the base of the
skull may have been fractured on the floor by the force of his fall.
We’ll see when we come to the P.M. But in any case that wound alone
would be quite sufficient to cause almost immediate death. It’s a
blade almost as broad as a bayonet, as you can see. I’ll go into the
whole thing carefully when I can make a thorough examination. You’ll
have him sent down to the mortuary, of course?”

“As soon as we’ve finished our work here.”

“Good. I’ll make a note or two now, if you don’t mind. Then I’ll leave
you to get on. As things are, there’s nothing there which you couldn’t
see for yourselves.”

He took out a pocket-book and began to jot down his notes.

“Just a moment, doctor,” Sir Clinton interposed. “I’ve got a patient
for you here. I’d like you to have a look at his hand and bandage up
some cuts before you go.”

Greenlaw nodded in agreement and went on with his note-taking.

“Now, Inspector,” Sir Clinton continued, “we’d better get this sword
out. Be sure to take all the care you can not to rub out any
finger-prints.”

Armadale obeyed, and after some cautious manœuvres he succeeded in
withdrawing the weapon, which he laid carefully on the top of the
central show-case.

“Now we can have a look at him,” Sir Clinton said. “You don’t mind our
shifting the position of the body, doctor?”

Greenlaw closed his note-book and prepared to assist them if
necessary.

“Begin with the contents of his pockets, Inspector,” Sir Clinton
suggested.

“The blade’s gone clean through his left breast pocket,” the Inspector
pointed out. He felt the outside of the pocket gingerly with his
fingers.

“Nothing there except his handkerchief, so far as I can feel. It’s all
soaked with his blood. I’ll leave that to the last. I want to keep my
hands clean while I go over the rest.”

He wiped his finger-tips carefully on his own handkerchief and
continued his search.

“Right-hand breast pocket: a note-case.”

He drew it out and handed it to Sir Clinton, who opened it and counted
the contents.

“Three hundred and fifty-seven pounds in notes,” he announced at
length. “That’s a fair sum to be carrying about with one. Ten visiting
cards: ‘J. B. Foss,’ with no address.”

He crossed over to the central case and put down the note-case
thoughtfully.

“The left-hand waistcoat pockets are saturated with blood,” Armadale
continued. “I’ll leave them over for the present. Top right-hand
waistcoat pocket, empty. Lower right-hand waistcoat pocket: a small
penknife and a tooth-pick. Not much blood here; he was lying slightly
on his left side and it must have flowed in that direction, I suppose.
Right-hand jacket pocket, outside: nothing. I’ll take the trousers
now. Right-hand pocket: key-ring and a purse.”

He handed them to Sir Clinton, who examined them in turn before
putting them on the central case.

“Only keys of suit-cases here,” the Chief Constable reported. “We
haven’t come across the latch-key of his flat, if you notice.”

He counted the contents of the purse.

“Eight and sixpence and one ten-shilling note.”

The Inspector proceeded with his examination.

“Here’s something funny! He’s got a smallish pocket over his hip, just
below the trouser button. That’s unusual. But it’s empty,” he added,
after an eager search.

“Let me look at that,” Sir Clinton demanded.

He stooped down and inspected the pocket closely, then stood up and
passed his hand across the corresponding spot on his own clothes. As
he did so, Armadale noticed a peculiar expression pass across the
Chief Constable’s face, as though some new idea had dawned upon him
and had cleared up a difficulty. But Sir Clinton divulged nothing of
what was passing in his mind.

“Make quite sure it’s empty,” he said.

Armadale turned the little pocket inside out.

“There’s nothing there,” he pointed out. “It wouldn’t hold much—it’s
hardly bigger than a ticket pocket.”

He looked at the pocket again, evidently puzzled by the importance
which the Chief Constable attached to it.

“It’s a silly place to have a pocket,” he said at last. “It’s not like
the old-fashioned fob. That was kept tight shut by the pressure of
your body. This thing’s mouth is loose and it’s simply a gift to a
pickpocket.”

“I think we’ll probably find another of the same kind on the other
side,” Sir Clinton contented himself with saying. “Let’s get on with
the rest of them.”

Armadale turned the body slightly and put his hand into the hip
pocket.

“It’s empty, too,” he announced. “It’s a very loose pocket with no
flap on it. I expect he carried his pistol there and he had the pocket
built for easy handling of his gun.”

He looked at the .38 automatic which had been disclosed as he turned
the body.

“That wouldn’t have fitted into the little pocket,” he pointed out.
“The pistol’s far too big for the opening.”

Sir Clinton nodded his agreement with this view.

“He didn’t use it for his pistol. Now, the left-hand pockets, please.
You can wash your hands as soon as you’ve gone through them.”

Inspector Armadale stolidly continued his investigation.

“Left-hand breast pocket in jacket,” he announced. “Nothing but his
handkerchief, saturated with blood.”

He handed it to Sir Clinton, who inspected it carefully before putting
it with the rest of the collection.

“No marks on it, either initials or laundry-mark,” he said. “Evidently
been bought and used without marking.”

“Ticket pocket, empty,” the Inspector went on, withdrawing his fingers
from it. “Top left waistcoat pocket: a self-filling Swan pen and a
metal holder for same. Lower left waistcoat pocket: an amber
cigarette-holder. Not much to go on there.”

He turned to the trousers.

“Left-hand trouser pocket: five coppers.”

Handing them over, he proceeded.

“Your notion’s quite right, sir. There’s another of these side pockets
here. But it’s empty like the other one.”

Instead of replying, Sir Clinton gingerly picked up the automatic
pistol from the floor and placed it along with the other objects on
the central case.

“You’d better examine that for finger-prints, Inspector,” he
suggested. “I leave you to make the arrangements about taking the body
down to the mortuary. The sooner the better. Now, doctor, we’ll get
your patient for you, if the Inspector will be good enough to bring
him to the lavatory near by, where you can get his wounds patched up.”

Inspector Armadale soon produced Marden, who seemed rather surprised
at being summoned again.

“It’s all right, Marden,” Sir Clinton assured him. “It merely struck
me that when there was a doctor on the premises you ought to have
these cuts of yours properly fixed up.”

Dr. Greenlaw speedily removed the temporary bandage which the valet
had improvised.

“I’ll need to put some stitches into this,” he said, as the extent of
the injury became evident. “Luckily these glass cuts are clean-edged.
You’ll hardly see the scar after a time.”

Sir Clinton inspected the wounds sympathetically.

“You’ve made a bit of a mess of your hand, Marden,” he commented.
“It’s just as well I thought of getting Dr. Greenlaw to look after
you.”

Marden seemed to have been looking for an opening.

“I’m glad you called me up again, sir,” he explained. “I’ve just
thought of two other points about this affair.”

“Yes?”

While the doctor was cleaning and disinfecting the wounds, Marden
addressed himself to the Chief Constable.

“I forgot to say, sir, that when I got back to the house I found Mr.
Foss’s car waiting for him. I said a word or two to the chauffeur as I
passed. It only struck me afterwards that this might be important. I
forgot about it at the time.”

“Quite right to tell us,” Sir Clinton confirmed.

“The second thing was what the chauffeur told me. He’d been ordered to
wait for Mr. Foss, it seems; and he got the idea that Mr. Foss was
leaving Ravensthorpe this afternoon for good. I was surprised by that;
for I’d heard nothing about it from Mr. Foss.”

He flinched slightly with the smart of his wounds, as Greenlaw washed
them carefully.

Sir Clinton seemed to be struck by a fresh idea.

“Before the doctor bandages you up, would you mind if we took your
finger-prints, Marden? I’m asking every one to let us take theirs, and
this seems to be the best chance we shall have of getting yours, you
see? Of course, if you object, I’ve no power to insist on it.”

“I’ve no objections, sir. Why should I have?”

“Then you might take impressions of the lot, Inspector,” Sir Clinton
suggested. “Don’t spend too much time over it. We must get the
bandages on this hand as quick as possible.”

Inspector Armadale hurried away for his outfit and soon set to work to
take the valet’s finger-prints. While he was thus engaged a fresh
suggestion seemed to occur to Sir Clinton.

“By the way, Marden, you have that parcel which Mr. Foss sent to the
post?”

“I can give you it in a moment, sir, once the doctor has finished with
my hand.”

“Very good. I’d like to see it.”

The Chief Constable waited patiently until Marden’s hand was
completely bandaged; then he dispatched the valet for the parcel. When
it was forthcoming, he dismissed Marden again. The doctor took his
leave, and Armadale was left alone with Sir Clinton.

“Now let’s see what Foss was sending off, Inspector.”

Cutting the string, Sir Clinton unwrapped the paper and disclosed a
small cardboard box. Inside on a layer of cotton-wool, was a
wrist-watch. Further search failed to bring to light any enclosed
note.

“I suppose he was sending it to be cleaned,” the Inspector hazarded.
“Probably he wrote a letter by the same post.”

“Let’s have a look at it, Inspector. Be careful not to mark it with
your fingers.”

Sir Clinton took the watch up and examined it closely.

“It looks fairly new to need repair.”

He held it to his ear.

“It’s going. Not much sign of damage there.”

“Perhaps it needed regulating,” Armadale suggested.

“Perhaps,” Sir Clinton’s tone was noncommittal. “Take a note of the
time as compared with your own watch, Inspector; and just check
whether it’s going fast or slow in a few hours. Try it for
finger-prints along with the rest of the stuff.”

He replaced it gently in its bed of cotton-wool and closed the box,
taking care not to finger the cardboard.

“Now, if you’ll send for the chauffeur, we may get something from
him.”

But the chauffeur proved a most unsatisfactory witness. He admitted
that Foss had ordered him to bring round the car at 3.15 and wait for
further orders; but he was unable to give any clear account of the
talk he had with his employer when the order was given.

“I can’t remember what he said exactly; but I got the notion he was
leaving here to-day. I’m dead sure of that; for I packed up my own
stuff and had it ready to go off at a moment’s notice. It’s on the
grid of the car now. I was so taken aback that I haven’t thought of
unpacking it.”

Sir Clinton could get nothing further out of the man, and he was
eventually dismissed.

“Now we’ll have a run over the late Mr. Foss’s goods,” the Chief
Constable proposed, when they had dismissed the chauffeur.

But the search of Foss’s bedroom yielded at first nothing of much
interest.

“This doesn’t look as if that chauffeur had been telling the truth,”
Armadale pointed out, when they found all Foss’s clothes arranged
quite normally in wardrobe and drawers. “Foss himself had made no
preparations for moving, that’s evident. I’ll see that chauffeur again
and go into the matter more carefully.”

“You might as well,” Sir Clinton concurred. “But I doubt if you’ll get
him to shift from his story. He seemed to be very clear about the main
point, though he was weak in details.”

They subjected all Foss’s belongings to a careful scrutiny.

“No name marked on any of the linen; no tags on any of the suits; no
labels inside the jacket pockets,” Inspector Armadale pointed out. “He
seems to have been very anxious not to advertise his identity. And no
papers of any sort. It looks a bit queer, doesn’t it?”

As he spoke, he noticed a small leather case standing in a corner.

“Hullo, here’s an attaché case. Perhaps his papers are in it.”

He crossed over and picked up the case, but as he did so an expression
of surprise crossed his face.

“This thing’s as heavy as lead! It must weigh ten or twelve pounds at
least!”

“It’s not an attaché case,” Sir Clinton pointed out. “Look at the ends
of it.”

Armadale turned the case round in his hand. At the upper part of one
end the leather had been cut away, disclosing a small ebonite disc
rather more than an inch in diameter and pierced with a pattern of
tiny holes. At the opposite end of the case there were two small holes
side by side and a larger one above; and examination showed brass
sockets inside which seemed meant for the reception of plugs.

“You’d better get his keys, Inspector. Probably the key of this thing
will be on the ring.”

With his curiosity raised to an acute pitch, Armadale went off in
search of the key-ring; and was soon back again with it in his hand.

“Now we’ll see what it is,” he said, as he turned the key in the
case’s lock and pressed the opening spring.

The lifting of the lid disclosed a wooden casing fitted with a couple
of hinged doors, an open recess in which were two levers, and a hinged
metal plate, on which was an inscription. Armadale read it aloud
uncomprehendingly:

“‘Marconi Otophone. Inst. No. S/O 1164.’ What the deuce is this?”

Sir Clinton put out his hand and lifted the hinged metal plate,
disclosing below two wireless valves in their sockets.

“Some wireless gadget,” the Inspector ejaculated. “Now what could he
possibly have wanted with a thing like that?”

Sir Clinton examined the instrument with interest, then he closed the
case.

“We’ll take this along with us, Inspector.”

Then, with a sudden change of mind, he contradicted himself.

“No, we’ll leave it here for the present. That will be much better.”

Somewhat mystified by this change of intention, the Inspector agreed.
Sir Clinton’s manner did not invite questions.

“I think we had better see Miss Chacewater again. There are one or two
questions I’d like to put to her, Inspector; and you had better be
there.”

In a minute or two, Joan was found, with Michael Clifton in
attendance. Sir Clinton did not think it worth while to sit down.

“Just a couple of points I want to ask about. First of all, is there
any record of the combination which opens the lock of the safe in the
museum?”

Joan shook her head.

“Maurice was the only one of us who knew it. My father did leave a
note of it; but I remember that Maurice destroyed that. He specially
wished to keep it to himself.”

“Another point,” Sir Clinton went on. “Did Foss know, on the night of
the burglary, which of the rows contained the real medallions and
which row the replicas were in?”

Joan reflected for a moment or two before replying.

“He must have known. Maurice had shown him the things once at least,
if not oftener; and I know there was no secret as to which were the
real things and which were the counterfeits.”

Sir Clinton seemed satisfied with this information.

“One last thing,” he continued. “I suppose you could show me where
your brother keeps his correspondence. We must get hold of Kessock’s
address and notify him about Foss’s death; and there seems no way of
doing it as quick as this one. If the papers aren’t locked up, perhaps
I could see them now?”

It appeared that the letters were available and Sir Clinton turned
them over rapidly.

“Fifth Avenue? That’s satisfactory.”

He put the papers back in their place.

“There’s just one thing more. I’m going to put a constable on guard at
the door of the museum for a while—day and night for a day or two,
perhaps. You won’t mind?”

“Certainly not. Do as you wish.”

Sir Clinton acknowledged the permission. Then, as though struck by an
after-thought, he inquired:

“Have you Cecil’s address?”

Joan shook her head.

“He said he’d let me know where he was staying, but he hasn’t written.
Perhaps he hasn’t settled down yet. He may be staying at an hotel for
a day or two.”

“Please ring me up as soon as he sends word.”

Joan promised to do this, and Sir Clinton continued:

“By the way, Inspector Armadale wishes to take the finger-prints of
every one in the house. Would you mind setting an example and having
yours taken along with the rest? If you do it, then it will be easier
for us to get the others. They won’t be suspicious when they hear that
it’s a general inquisition.”

Both Joan and Michael consented without ado.

“The Inspector will be with you in a moment or two,” Sir Clinton said,
as he took his leave. “Just a word with you, Inspector.”

Armadale followed him from the room.

“Now, Inspector, there’s a lot for you to do yet. First of all, get
these finger-prints. Then telephone to London and get Kessock’s
business address. As soon as you get it, let me know.”

“But you got his address from the correspondence, sir, surely. It’s in
Fifth Avenue.”

“I want his other address—his office in New York, you understand?”

“His office will be shut by now, if you’re going to cable,” the
Inspector pointed out, thoughtlessly.

“No, it won’t. You forget that their time is some hours behind ours.
We’ll catch him in office hours if you hurry. Then when you’ve done
that, get Foss’s face photographed; and arrange for a constable and
reliefs to be posted at the museum door till further orders. The
museum door is to be left open and the light is to be left burning at
night, so that he can keep his eye on things.”

Inspector Armadale jotted some notes in his pocket-book. As he closed
this, he seemed to think of something.

“There’s just one thing, sir. You want to get into the safe? Couldn’t
we get the number of the lock combination from the makers? They must
know it.”

Sir Clinton shook his head.

“Unfortunately the safe has no maker’s name-plate on it, Inspector. I
looked at the time we examined it. It’s a fairly old pattern, though,
I noticed; and if it hasn’t got a balanced fence arbour, I think I can
guarantee to find the combination of it with a little assistance.”

Armadale looked rather blank.

“I thought these things were too stiff to tackle,” he said.

Sir Clinton suppressed a smile.

“You ought to read Edgar Allan Poe, Inspector. ‘Human ingenuity cannot
concoct a cipher which human ingenuity cannot resolve,’ was a dictum
of his. If I’m not mistaken about that safe, I think I could guarantee
to open it in less than ten minutes. The resources of science, and all
that, you know. But I think it would be better to wait a while and see
if Mr. Chacewater turns up to open it for us himself.”

“But perhaps Mr. Chacewater’s body is inside it now,” the Inspector
suggested. “There may have been a double murder, for all we know.”

“In that case, we shall find him when we open it,” Sir Clinton assured
him lightly. “If he’s inside, he’ll hardly be likely to shift his
quarters.”



CHAPTER X

The Shot in the Clearing

When Sir Clinton reached his office on the morning after the murder at
Ravensthorpe, he found Inspector Armadale awaiting him with a number
of exhibits.

“I’ve brought everything that seemed worth while,” Armadale explained.
“I thought you might care to look at some of the things again,
although you’ve seen them already.”

“That’s very good of you, Inspector. I should like to see some of
them, as a matter of fact. Now suppose we begin with the
finger-prints. They might suggest a few fresh ideas.”

“They seem to suggest more notions than I have room for in my head,”
the Inspector confessed ruefully. “It’s a most tangled case, to my
mind.”

“Then let’s start with the finger-prints,” the Chief Constable
proposed. “At least they’ll settle some points, I hope.”

Armadale unwrapped a large brown-paper parcel.

“I got the lot without any difficulty; and last night we photographed
them all and enlarged the pictures. They’re all here.”

“You took Foss’s, I suppose?”

“Yes, and I managed to find some of Maurice Chacewater’s too.”

“That’s pretty sharp work,” Sir Clinton complimented his subordinate.
“How did you manage to make sure they were his?”

“I asked for his set of razors, sir, and took them from the blades.
He’d left prints here and there of his finger and thumb, either on the
blade or on the handle. Of course I couldn’t get anything else very
sharp; but there are quite enough for the purpose, as you’ll see.”

He laid out three enlarged photographs on the desk before Sir Clinton;
then, below each of the first two, he put down a second print.

“This first print,” he said, pointing to it, “represents the
finger-prints we found on the automatic pistol. You can see that it’s
the arch pattern on the thumb. Now here”—he indicated the companion
print—“is Foss’s thumb-print; and if you look at it, you’ll see almost
at a glance that it’s identical with the print on the pistol. They’re
identical. I’ve measured them. And there are no other prints except
Foss’s on the pistol.”

“Good,” said Sir Clinton. “‘And that, said John, is that.’ We know
where we are so far as the pistol’s concerned. Pass along, please.”

“I’ve examined the pistol,” the Inspector continued. “It’s fully
loaded in the magazine and has an extra cartridge in the barrel; but
it hasn’t been fired recently so far as I can see.”

“Now for the next pair of prints,” Sir Clinton suggested.

“This represents the thumb-print from the sword, or whatever you call
it,” said the Inspector. “Also prints of the two middle fingers of the
right hand, found on the weapon. The second print of the pair shows
identical finger-prints from a different source. The thumb-prints in
the two cases are not exactly alike, because you get only the edge of
the thumb marked in the grip of a sword, whereas the other specimen
gives a full imprint. But I think you’ll find they’re the same. I’ve
measured them, too. You can see that the thumb pattern is a loop type,
quite different from Foss’s prints; and there’s a trace of a tiny scar
at the edge of the thumb in both these prints. I’d like you to compare
them carefully, sir.”

Sir Clinton took up the two prints and scanned them with care,
comparing the images point by point.

“There’s no mistake possible,” he said. “The two sets are identical,
so far as I can see; and the scar on the thumb is a clinching bit of
evidence.”

“You admit they’re from the same hand?” asked the Inspector, with a
peculiar look at Sir Clinton.

“Undoubtedly. Now whose are the second set?”

The Inspector continued to look at his superior with something out of
the common in his expression.

“The second set of prints came from Maurice Chacewater’s razors,” he
said.

The Chief Constable’s lips set tightly and a touch of grimness showed
in his face.

“I see we shall have to be quite clear about this, Inspector,” he
said, bluntly. “By the look of you, you seemed to think I’d be taken
aback by this evidence, because Mr. Chacewater is a friend of mine. I
was taken aback—naturally enough. But if you think it’s going to make
any difference to the conduct of this case—and I seemed to see
something of the sort in your face—you can put that out of your mind
once for all. The business of the police is to get hold of the
murderer, whoever he may be. Friendship doesn’t come into these
affairs, Inspector. So kindly don’t suspect me of anything of that
kind in future. You know what I mean; I needn’t put it into words.”

Without giving Armadale time for reply, he picked up the last print.

“What’s this?”

“It’s the set of prints I took from the valet’s fingers,” the
Inspector hastened to explain. “It corresponds to nothing I’ve found
anywhere else. You can see it’s a whorl type on the thumb.”

Sir Clinton examined the print for a moment or two, then put it down.

“What about the box and the wrist-watch?” he asked.

Inspector Armadale’s face showed that here he was puzzled.

“There’s nothing on either of them—not a recent mark of any
description. And yet the man who packed them up must have fingered
both things.”

“With gloves on, evidently.”

“But why gloves?” the Inspector demanded.

“Why gloves?” Sir Clinton echoed, rather sarcastically. “To avoid
leaving finger-prints, of course. That’s obvious.”

“But why avoid leaving finger-prints on a thing that you’re sending to
a jeweller for repair?”

“Think it over, Inspector. I won’t insult you by telling you my
solution. Let’s take another point. Have you the watch itself here?”

The Inspector produced it and handed it over. Sir Clinton took out a
pocket-knife and opened the back of the case.

“No use,” he announced, after examining the back cover carefully.
“It’s never been repaired. There are no reference marks scratched on
the inside of the back as there usually are when a watch has gone back
to the watch-makers. If there had been, we might have found out
something about Foss in that way, by getting hold of the watch-makers.
By the way, have you timed this thing as I asked you to do?”

“It’s running on time,” Armadale answered. “It hasn’t varied a rap in
the last twelve hours.”

“A practically new watch; running to time; never needed repair so far;
dispatched by post with no finger-marks of the dispatcher: surely you
can see what that means?”

Inspector Armadale shook his head.

“It might be a secret message,” he hazarded, though without much
confidence. “I mean a prearranged code.”

“So it might,” Sir Clinton agreed. “The only thing against that in my
mind is that I’m perfectly sure that it wasn’t.”

Armadale looked sulky.

“I’m hardly clever enough to follow you, sir, I’m afraid.”

Sir Clinton’s expression grew momentarily stern; but the shade passed
from his face almost instantly.

“This is one of these cases, Inspector, where I think that two heads
are better than one. Now if I tell you what’s in my mind, it might
tempt you to look at things exactly as I do; and then we’d have lost
the advantage of having two brains at work on the business
independently. We’re more likely to be usefully employed if we pool
the facts and keep our interpretations separate from each other.”

The tone of the Chief Constable’s voice went a good way towards
soothing the Inspector’s ruffled feelings, the more so since he saw
the weight of Sir Clinton’s reasoning.

“I’m sorry, sir. I quite see your point now.”

Sir Clinton had the knack of leaving no ill-feelings in his
subordinates. By an almost imperceptible change of manner, he
dismissed the whole matter and restored cordiality again.

“Let’s get back to the pure facts, Inspector. Each of us must look at
them in his own way; but we can at least examine some of them without
biasing each other. Did you get any more information out of that
chauffeur?”

Inspector Armadale seemed glad enough to forget the slight friction
between himself and his Chief, as the tone of his voice showed when he
replied.

“I could get nothing out of him at all, sir. He seems a stupid sort of
fellow. But it was quite clear that somehow or other he’d picked up
the idea that Foss meant to leave Ravensthorpe for good yesterday
afternoon. He stuck to that definitely; and the packing up of his
traps shows that he believed it.”

“We can take it, then, that Foss gave reason for the man thinking that
he was going away. Put your own interpretation on that, Inspector; but
you needn’t tell me what you make of it.”

The Inspector’s smile showed that ill-feeling had gone.

“Very well, Sir Clinton. And I’ll admit that I had my suspicions of
the valet. He seems to have a clear bill now in the matter of the
finger-prints on the weapon. Perhaps I was a bit rough on the man; but
he annoyed me—a cheeky fellow.”

“Oh, don’t let’s use hard words about him,” Sir Clinton suggested
chaffingly. “Let’s call him cool, simply.”

“Well, his finger-prints weren’t on the handle of the sword, anyhow,”
the Inspector admitted.

“I hardly expected them to be,” was all the comment Sir Clinton saw
fit to make. “Now what about friend Foss? By the way, I don’t mind
saying that I still think these two affairs at Ravensthorpe are
interconnected. And one thing’s clear at any rate: Foss wasn’t the man
in white. You remember he was wearing a cow-boy costume according to
the valet’s evidence; and we found that costume in his wardrobe, which
confirms Marden.”

The Inspector seemed to be taking a leaf out of Sir Clinton’s book. He
refrained from either acquiescing in or contradicting the Chief
Constable’s statement that the two cases were linked.

“Foss had more ready money in his pocket than most people carry; he
was in a position to clear out of Ravensthorpe at any moment without
needing to go back to his flat or even to a bank. I think these facts
are plain enough,” he pointed out. “And they fit in with the
chauffeur’s evidence, such as it is.”

“And he had no latch-key of his flat with him,” Sir Clinton
supplemented. “Of course it was a service flat and he may have left
the key behind him instead of carrying it with him. One could find
that out if it were worth while.”

“There’s a good deal that needs explaining about Foss,” the Inspector
observed. “I’ve got his photograph here, taken from the body
yesterday.”

He produced it as he spoke.

“Send a copy to Scotland Yard, Inspector, please, and ask if they have
any information about him. Considering everything, it’s quite likely
we might learn something. You might send his finger-prints also, to
see if they have them indexed there.”

“I’ll send Marden’s too, when I’m at it,” the Inspector volunteered,
“and the chauffeur’s. We might as well be complete when we’re at it.”

Sir Clinton indicated his agreement without saying anything. He
changed the subject when he next spoke.

“We’ve agreed to pool the facts, Inspector, and I’ve got a
contribution—two contributions in fact—towards the common stock.
Here’s the first.”

He laid a telegraph form on the desk before Armadale, and the
Inspector read the wording:

  Have no agent named Foss am not negotiating for Leonardo medallions.
  Kessock.

“Well, that’s a bit of a surprise!” ejaculated the Inspector. “It was
obvious that there was something fishy; but I hadn’t imagined it was
as fishy as all that. Kessock knows nothing about him, then?”

“My cable was fairly explicit. It’s clear that friend Foss had no
authority from Kessock.”

“But what about all that correspondence between Maurice Chacewater and
Kessock that we saw?”

“Forgeries, so far as the Kessock letters were concerned, obviously.
One of Kessock’s household must have been in league with Foss and
intercepted Maurice Chacewater’s letters. Then replies were forged and
dispatched. I’ve cabled Kessock about it this morning, so as to get
the news in at once. The confederate may hear of Foss’s murder through
the newspapers in four or five days when our papers get across there.
He might bolt when he got the news. I’ve given Kessock a chance to
forestall that if he wants to.”

“That puts a new light on things, certainly,” Armadale said when he
had considered the new facts. “Foss was a wrong ’un masquerading here
for some purpose or other—the medallions, probably. That fits in with
all the unmarked linen and the rest of it. But why was he murdered?”

Sir Clinton disregarded the question.

“I’ve got another fact to contribute,” he went on. “You remember that
Marconi Otophone in Foss’s room? I’ve made some inquiries about it.
It’s a thing they make for the use of deaf people—a modern substitute
for the ear-trumpet.”

The Inspector made a gesture of bewilderment.

“But Foss wasn’t deaf! He admitted to you that he had good enough
hearing, when he was telling you about overhearing Foxton Polegate in
the winter-garden.”

“That’s quite true,” Sir Clinton rejoined. “But he evidently needed an
Otophone for all that.”

The Inspector pondered for a few moments before speaking.

“It beats me,” he said at last.

Sir Clinton dismissed the subject without further discussion.

“Now what about Maurice Chacewater?” he inquired. “There’s no great
difficulty in suggesting _how_ he disappeared from the museum. It’s
common talk hereabout that Ravensthorpe has secret passages; and one
of them may end up in the wall of the museum.”

It was the turn of Armadale to contribute a fresh fact.

“He didn’t appear at any local station yesterday or this morning; and
he didn’t use a motor of any sort that I’ve been able to trace. I’ve
had men on that job and it’s been thoroughly done.”

“Congratulations, Inspector.”

“If he hasn’t got away, then he must be somewhere in the neighborhood
still.”

“I should say that was indisputable, if not certain,” commented Sir
Clinton, with a return of his faintly chaffing manner. “A man can only
be in one place at once, if you follow me. And if he’s not there, then
he must be here.”

“Yes. But where is ‘here,’ in this particular case?” inquired
Armadale, following his Chief’s mood. “I expect he’s hiding somewhere
around. It’s what any one might do if they found themselves up to the
hilt in a case of murder”—he paused for an instant—“or manslaughter,
and got into a panic over it.”

Sir Clinton ignored the Inspector’s last sentence.

“I wish I could get into touch with Cecil Chacewater. He ought to be
at home just now. He’s the only man in the family now, and he ought to
take charge of things up there.”

“You haven’t got his address yet, sir?”

“Not yet.”

Sir Clinton put the subject aside.

“Now, Inspector, let me remind you of what’s wanted:

    What was the crime, who did it, when was it done, and where,
    How done, and with what motive, who in the deed did share?

You put it down as murder?”

“Or manslaughter,” corrected Armadale. “And we know When, How, and
Where, at any rate.”

“Do we?” Sir Clinton rejoined. “Speak for yourself. I’m not so sure
about When and Where yet, and How is still a dark mystery so far as
I’m concerned. I mean,” he added, “so far as legal proof goes.”

The Inspector was about to say something further when a knock at the
door was heard and a constable appeared in answer to Sir Clinton’s
summons.

“The Ravensthorpe head keeper wants to see you, Sir Clinton, if you
can spare him a moment. He says it’s important.”

The Chief Constable ordered the keeper to be admitted.

“Well, Mold, what’s your trouble?” he inquired, when the man appeared.

“It’s this way, Sir Clinton,” Mold began. “Seein’ the queer sort o’
things we’ve seen lately, it seemed to me that maybe another queer
thing that’s happened might be important. So I thought it over, and I
made bold to come and tell you about it.”

He seemed to lose confidence a little at this point; but Sir Clinton
encouraged him by a show of interest.

“Last night,” he went on, “I was goin’ through the wood at the back o’
the house—about eleven o’clock it was, as near as I can make it. At
the back o’ the house there’s a strip of woodland, then a little bit
of a clearin’, and then the rest of the wood. I’d come out o’ the
bigger bit o’ the wood and got most o’ the way across the clearin’
when it happened. I can tell you just where it was, for I was passin’
the old ruin there—the Knight’s Tower they call it.”

He paused for a moment or two, evidently finding continuous narrative
rather a strain.

“The moon was well up by that time. It’s just past the full these
days; and the place was as clear as day. Everythin’ was quiet, except
an old owl that lives in a hollow tree up by there. I could hear the
swish of my feet in the grass and mighty little else; for the grass
was dewy and made a lot o’ noise with my stepping through it. Well, as
I was goin’ along, all of a sudden I heard a shot. It sounded close by
me; an’ I turned at once. There’s a poachin’ chap that’s given me a
lot o’ trouble, an’ I didn’t put it past him to think he might be
tryin’ to give me a scare. But when I turned round there was nothin’
to be seen. There was nothin’ there at all; an’ yet that shot had come
from quite close by.”

“Did it sound like the report of a shot-gun?” Sir Clinton asked.

Mold seemed to be in a difficulty.

“Shot-gun sounds I know fairly well. ’T weren’t from a shot-gun. More
like a pistol-shot it sounded, when I’d had time to think over it. An’
yet it weren’t altogether like a pistol-shot, neither. That’s a sharp
sound. This was more booming-like, if you understand me.”

“I’m afraid I don’t quite see it yet, Mold,” Sir Clinton admitted. “I
know how difficult it is to describe sounds, though. Have another try.
Did it remind you of anything?”

A light seemed to flicker for a moment in Mold’s memory.

“I know!” he exclaimed. “It was like this. I’ve got it! Did you ever
stand at the door of our Morris-tube range in the village while there
was firin’ goin’ on inside? Well, this was somethin’ like that, only
more so. I mean as if they’d fired somethin’ a bit heavier than a
miniature rifle. That’s it! That’s just how it sounded.”

He was evidently relieved by having found what he considered an apt
simile.

“What happened after that?” Sir Clinton demanded.

“When I saw nobody near me I’ll admit I felt a bit funny. Here was a
shot comin’, so it seemed, out o’ the empty air, with nothin’ to
account for it. Straight away, I’ll admit, sir, I began thinkin’ of
that Black Man that little Jennie Hitchin has been spreadin’ the story
about lately . . .”

Sir Clinton pricked up his ears.

“We’ll hear about the Black Man later on, Mold, if you please. Tell us
what you did at that moment.”

“Well, sir, I searched about. The moon was clear of clouds and the
place was just an open glade. The shot had come from quite near by, as
I said. But when I hunted I could find nothing. There wasn’t a track
in the dew on the grass. My own tracks showed up in the moonlight as
clear as clear. There wasn’t any one hiding in the old ruin; I went
through and around it twice. There wasn’t a sound; for the shot had
frightened the owl. I found nothing. And yet I’d take my oath that
shot was fired not more than ten or a dozen yards away from me.”

“Did you hear any whistle of shot or a bullet?”

“No, sir.”

“H’m! That’s the whole story? Now, tell us about this Black Man you
mentioned.”

Mold seemed rather ashamed.

“Oh, that’s just child’s chatter, Sir Clinton. I oughtn’t to have
mentioned it.”

“I’m quite willing to listen to ‘child’s chatter,’ Mold, if it happens
to be unusual.”

Mold evidently decided to take the plunge, though obviously he
regretted having mentioned the matter at all.

“This Jennie Hitchin’s a child that lives with her grandmother on the
estate. The girl’s there at night in case anything goes wrong with the
old woman. Old Mrs. Hitchin was taken ill one night lately, about the
middle of the night. Pretty bad she seemed; and Jennie had to dress
and go off for the doctor in a hurry. That took her through the
woods—it’s a short cut that way and the moonlight was bright. An’ as
she was goin’ along . . .”

“What night was this,” Sir Clinton interrupted.

The keeper thought for a moment or two.

“Now I come to think of it,” he said, “’t was the night of that
robbery up at Ravensthorpe. So it was. An’ as Jennie was goin’ along
through the woods she saw—so she says—a Black Man slippin’ about from
tree to tree.”

“A man in dark clothes?”

“No, sir. If I understood rightly, ’t was a black man. I mean a naked
man with a black skin, black all over.”

“Did he molest the child?”

“No, sir. He seemed to be tryin’ to keep out of her road if anythin’.
But o’ course it gave her a start. She took and ran—and small blame to
her, I think. She’s only eleven or so, an’ it gave her a dreadful
fright. An’ of course next day this tale was all over the
country-side. I wonder if you didn’t hear it yourself, sir.”

“It’s news to me, Mold, I’m afraid. Even the police can’t know
everything, you see. Now before you go I want something more from you.
That night when you were on guard in the museum, you remember. Do you
recall seeing any one there at any time during the evening dressed in
cow-boy clothes? You know, the kind of thing in the Wild West films.”

Mold pondered for a time, evidently racking his memory.

“No, sir. I remember nobody like that. I think I’d have recalled it if
I had. I’m rather keen on films about cow-boys myself, and if I’d seen
a cow-boy I’d have had a good look at him, just out o’ curiosity.”

Sir Clinton had apparently got all he needed from Mold just then; and
he sent him away quite reassured that his visit had not been wasted.

“What do you make of all that, Inspector?” he inquired with a faintly
quizzical expression on his face, as soon as the door had closed
behind the keeper.

Armadale shook his head. Then, seeing a chance of scoring, he smiled
openly.

“I was to keep my ideas to myself, you remember, Sir Clinton.”

The Chief Constable gave him smile for smile.

“That arrangement must be especially useful when you’ve no ideas at
all, Inspector.”

Armadale took the thrust with good humour.

“Give me time to think, Sir Clinton. You know I’ve only a slow mind,
and perhaps this isn’t one of my bright days.”

Before Sir Clinton could retort the desk telephone rang and the Chief
Constable lifted the receiver.

“Yes, I am . . . Thanks very much. I’ll take down the address if
you’ll read it to me.”

He jotted something down on a sheet of paper.

“Thanks. Good-bye, Joan.”

He flicked the note over to Armadale.

“Would you mind seeing if we can get on to that house by ’phone,
Inspector? Hunt up the London Directory for it.”

“It’s Cecil Chacewater’s address?” said Armadale, glancing at the
slip.

“Yes. The man he’s staying with may be on the ’phone.”

In a few minutes the Inspector came back with the number and Sir
Clinton rang up. After a short talk he put down the receiver and
turned to Armadale.

“He says he can’t come to-day. You heard me explaining that we want
that secret passage opened, if there is one. But he doesn’t seem to
think there’s any hurry. He has some business which will keep him till
to-morrow.”

“I heard you tell him that his brother’s disappeared,” the Inspector
commented. “I’d have thought that would have brought him back quick
enough.”

“It hasn’t, evidently,” was all that Sir Clinton thought it necessary
to say. There seemed to be no reason for admitting the Inspector into
the secret of the Ravensthorpe quarrels.



CHAPTER XI

Underground Ravensthorpe

When Inspector Armadale presented himself at the Chief Constable’s
office next morning he found Sir Clinton still faithful to his
proposed policy of pooling all the facts of the case.

“I’ve just been in communication with the coroner,” Sir Clinton
explained. “I’ve pointed out to him that possibly we may have further
evidence for the inquest on Foss; and I suggested that he might
confine himself to formalities as far as possible and then adjourn for
a day or two. It means keeping Marden and the chauffeur here for a
little longer; but they can stay at Ravensthorpe. Miss Chacewater has
no objections to that. She agreed at once when I asked her.”

“The jury will have enough before them to bring in a verdict of murder
against some one unknown,” the Inspector pointed out. “Do you want to
make it more definite while we’re in the middle of the case?”

Sir Clinton made a noncommittal gesture as he replied:

“Let’s give ourselves the chance, at least, of putting a name on the
criminal. If we don’t succeed there’s no harm done. Now here’s another
point. I’ve had a telephone message from Scotland Yard. They’ve
nothing on record corresponding to the finger-prints of Marden or the
chauffeur. Foss was a wrong ’un. They’ve identified his finger-prints;
and his photograph seems to have been easily recognizable by some of
the Yard people who had dealings with him before. He went by the name
of Cocoa Tom among his intimates; but his real name was Thomas
Pailton. He’d been convicted a couple of times, though not recently.”

“What was his line?” the Inspector inquired.

“Confidence trick in one form or another, they say. Very plausible
tongue, apparently.”

“Did they say anything more about him?” asked the Inspector. “Anything
about working with a gang usually, or something like that? If he did,
then we might get a clue or two from his associates.”

“He usually played a lone hand, it seems,” Sir Clinton answered.
“Apparently he used to be on the Halls—the cheaper kind. ‘The
Wonderful Wizard of Woz’ he called himself then. But somehow they made
the business too hot for him and he cleared out into swindling.”

“Ah!” Armadale evidently saw something which had not occurred to him
before. “Those pockets of his—the ones that puzzled me. They might
have been useful to a man who could do a bit of sleight-of-hand. I
never thought of that at the time.”

He looked accusingly at Sir Clinton, who laughed at the expression in
the Inspector’s eyes.

“Of course I admit I saw the use of the pockets almost at once,” he
said. “But that’s not a breach of our bargain, Inspector. The facts
are all that we are pooling, remember; and the fact that Foss had
these peculiar pockets was as well known to you as to myself. This
notion about sleight-of-hand is an interpretation of the facts,
remember; and we weren’t to share our inferences.”

“I knew pretty well at the time that you’d spotted something,”
Armadale contented himself with saying. “But since you put it in that
way I’ll admit you were quite justified in keeping it to yourself as
special information, sir. I take it that it’s a race between us now;
and the one that hits on the solution first is the winner. I don’t
mind.”

“Then there’s one other bit of information needed to bring us level.
I’ve just had a message over the ’phone from Mr. Cecil Chacewater. It
appears he’s just got home again; came by the first train in the
morning from town, apparently. He’s waiting for us now, so we’d better
go up to Ravensthorpe. I have an idea that he may be able to throw
some light on his brother’s disappearance. At least he may be able to
show us how that disappearing trick was done; and that would always be
a step forward.”

When they reached Ravensthorpe Cecil was awaiting them. The inspector
noticed that he seemed tired and had a weary look in his eyes.

“Been out on the spree,” was Armadale’s silent inference; for the
Inspector was inclined to take a low view of humanity in general, and
he put his own interpretation on Cecil’s looks.

Sir Clinton, in a few rapid sentences, apprised Cecil of the facts of
the case.

“I’d heard some of that before, you know,” Cecil admitted. “Maurice’s
disappearance seems to have caused a bit of a stir. I can’t say he’s
greatly missed for the sake of his personality; but naturally it’s
disturbing to have a brother mislaid about the place.”

“Very irksome, of course,” agreed Sir Clinton, with a faint parody of
Cecil’s detached air.

Cecil seemed to think that the conversation had come to a deadlock,
since the Chief Constable made no effort to continue.

“Well, what about it?” he demanded. “I haven’t got Maurice concealed
anywhere about my person, you know.”

He elaborately felt in an empty jacket pocket, ending by turning it
inside out.

“No,” he pointed out, “he isn’t there. In fact, I’m almost certain I
haven’t got him anywhere in this suit.”

Cecil’s studied insolence seemed to escape Sir Clinton’s notice.

“There was a celebrated historical character who said something of the
same sort once upon a time. ‘Am I my brother’s keeper?’ you remember
that?”

“Good old Cain? So he did. And his name begins with a C, just like
mine, too! Any other points of resemblance you’d like to suggest?”

“Not just now,” Sir Clinton responded. “Information would be more to
the purpose at present. Let’s go along to the museum, please. There
are one or two points which need to be cleared up as soon as
possible.”

Cecil made no open demur; but his manner continued to be obviously
hostile as they made their way along the passages. At the museum door
the constable on guard stood aside in order to let them pass in.

“Wait a moment,” Sir Clinton ordered, as his companions were about to
enter the room. “I want to try an experiment before we go any
further.”

He turned to Cecil.

“Will you go across and stand in front of the case in which the
Muramasa sword used to be kept? You’ll find the sheath still in the
case. And you, Inspector, go to the spot where we found Foss’s body.”

When they had obeyed him he swung the door round on its hinges until
it was almost closed, and then looked through the remaining opening.

“Say a few words in an ordinary tone, Inspector. A string of addresses
or something of that sort.”

“William Jones, Park Place, Amersley Royal,” began the Inspector,
obediently; “Henry Blenkinsop, 18 Skeening Road, Hinchley; John Orran
Gordon, 88 Bolsover Lane . . .”

“That will be enough, thanks. I can hear you quite well. Now lower
your voice a trifle and say ‘Muramasa,’ ‘Japanese,’ and ‘sword,’
please. And mix them into the middle of some more addresses.”

The Inspector’s tone as he spoke showed plainly that he was a trifle
bewildered by his instructions.

“Fred Hall, Muramasa, Endelmere; Harry Bell, 15 Elm Japanese Avenue,
Stonyton; J. Hicky, sword, The Cottage, Apperley . . . Will that do?”

“Quite well, Inspector. Many thanks. Think I’m mad? All I wanted was
to find out how much a man in this position could see and hear.
Contributions to the pool. First, I can see the case where the
Muramasa sword used to lie. Second, I can hear quite plainly what
you’re saying. The slight echo in the room doesn’t hinder that.”

He swung the door open and came into the museum.

“Now, Cecil,” he said—and the Inspector noticed that all sign of
lightness had gone out of his tone, “you know that Maurice disappeared
rather mysteriously from this room? He was in it with Foss; there was
a man at the door; Foss was murdered in that bay over there; and
Maurice didn’t leave the room by the door. How did he leave?”

“How should I know?” demanded Cecil, sullenly. “You’d better ask him
when he turns up again. I’m not Maurice’s nursemaid.”

Sir Clinton’s eyes grew hard.

“I’ll put it plainer for you. I’ve reason to believe that there’s an
entrance to a secret passage somewhere in that bay beyond the safe.
It’s the only way in which Maurice could have left this room. You’ll
have to show it to us.”

“Indeed!” Cecil’s voice betrayed nothing but contempt for the
suggestion.

“It’s for your own benefit that I make the proposal,” Sir Clinton
pointed out. “Refuse if you like. But if you do I’ve a search-warrant
in my pocket and I mean to find that entrance even if I have to root
out most of the panelling and gut the room. You won’t avert the
discovery by this attitude of yours. You’ll merely make the whole
business public. It would be far more sensible to recognize the
inevitable and show us the place yourself. I don’t want to damage
things any more than is necessary. But if I’m put to it I’ll be
thorough, I warn you.”

Cecil favoured the Chief Constable with an angry look; but the
expression on Sir Clinton’s face convinced him that it was useless to
offer any further opposition.

“Very well,” he snarled. “I’ll open the thing, since I must.”

Sir Clinton took no notice of his anger.

“So long as you open it the rest doesn’t matter. I’ve no desire to pry
into things that don’t concern me. I don’t wish to know how the panel
opens. Inspector, I think we’ll turn our backs while Mr. Chacewater
works the mechanism.”

They faced about. Cecil took a few steps into the bay. There was a
sharp snap; and when they turned round again a door gaped in the
panelling at the end of the room.

“Quite so,” said Sir Clinton. “Most ingenious.”

His voice had regained its normal easy tone; and now he seemed anxious
to smooth over the ill-feeling which had come to so acute a pitch in
the last few minutes.

“Will you go first, Cecil, and show us the way? I expect it’s
difficult for a stranger. I’ve brought an electric torch. Here, you’d
better take it.”

Now that he had failed in his attempt, Cecil seemed to recover his
temper again. He took the torch from the Chief Constable and, pressing
the spring to light it, stepped through the open panel.

“I think we’ll lock the museum door before we go down,” Sir Clinton
suggested. “There’s no need to expose this entrance to any one who
happens to come in.”

He walked across the museum, turned the key in the lock, and then
rejoined his companions.

“Now, Cecil, if you please.”

Cecil Chacewater led the way; Sir Clinton motioned to the Inspector to
follow him, and brought up the rear himself.

“Look out, here,” Cecil warned them. “There’s a flight of steps almost
at once.”

They made their way down a spiral staircase which seemed to lead deep
into the foundations of Ravensthorpe. At last it came to an end, and a
narrow tunnel gaped before them.

“Nothing here, you see,” Cecil pointed out, flashing the torch in
various directions. “This passage is the only outlet.”

He led the way into the tunnel, followed by the Inspector. Sir Clinton
lagged behind them for a moment or two, and then showed no signs of
haste, so that they had to pause in order to let him catch up.

The tunnel led them in a straight line for a time, then bent in a
fresh direction.

“It’s getting narrower,” the Inspector pointed out.

“It gets narrower still before you’re done with it,” Cecil vouchsafed
in reply.

As the passage turned again Sir Clinton halted.

“I’d like to have a look at these walls,” he said.

Cecil turned back and threw the light of the torch over the sides and
roof of the tunnel.

“It’s very old masonry,” he pointed out.

Sir Clinton nodded.

“This is a bit of old Ravensthorpe, I suppose?”

“It’s older than the modern parts of the building,” Cecil agreed. He
seemed to have overcome his ill-humour and to be making the best of
things.

“Let’s push on, then,” Sir Clinton suggested. “I’ve seen all I wanted
to see, thanks.”

As they proceeded, the tunnel walls drew nearer together and the roof
grew lower. Before long the passage was barely large enough to let
them walk along it without brushing the stones on either side.

“Wait a moment,” Sir Clinton suggested, as they reached a fresh
turning. “Inspector, would you mind making a rough measurement of the
dimensions here?”

Somewhat mystified, Inspector Armadale did as he was bidden, entering
the figures up in his note-book while Cecil stood back, evidently
equally puzzled by these manœuvres.

“Thanks, that will do nicely,” Sir Clinton assured him when the task
had been completed. “Suppose we continue?”

Cecil advanced a few steps. Then a thought seemed to strike him.

“It gets narrower farther on. We’ll have to go on hands and knees, and
there won’t be room to pass one another. Perhaps one of you should go
first with the torch. There’s nothing in the road.”

Sir Clinton agreed to this.

“I’ll go first, then. You can follow on, Inspector.”

Inspector Armadale looked suspicious at this suggestion.

“He might get away back and shut us in,” he murmured in Sir Clinton’s
ear.

The Chief Constable took the simplest way of reassuring the Inspector.

“That’s an ingenious bit of mechanism in the panel, up above,” he said
to Cecil. “I had a glance at it as I passed, since it’s all in plain
sight. From this side, you’ve only to lift a bar to open it, haven’t
you?”

“That’s so,” Cecil confirmed.

Armadale was evidently satisfied by the information which Sir Clinton
had thus conveyed to him indirectly. He squeezed himself against the
wall and allowed the Chief Constable to come up to the head of the
party. Sir Clinton threw his light down the passage in front of them.

“It looks like all-fours, now,” he commented, as the lamp revealed a
steadily diminishing tunnel. “We may as well begin now and save
ourselves the chance of knocking our heads against the roof.”

Suiting the action to the word, he got down on hands and knees and
began to creep along the passage.

“At least we may be thankful it’s dry,” he pointed out.

The tunnel grew still smaller until they found more than a little
difficulty in making their way along it.

“Have we much farther to go?” asked the Inspector, who seemed to have
little liking for the business.

“The end’s round the next corner,” Cecil explained.

They soon reached the last bend in the passage, and as he turned it
Sir Clinton found himself at the entrance to a tiny space. The roof
was even lower than that of the tunnel, and the floor area was hardly
more than a dozen square feet. A stone slab, raised a few inches from
the ground, seemed like a bed fitted into a niche.

“A bit wet in this part,” Sir Clinton remarked. “If I’d known that we
were in for this sort of thing I think I’d have put on an old suit
this morning. Mind your knees on the floor, Inspector. It’s fairly
moist.”

He climbed into the niche, which was no bigger than the bunk of a
steamer, and began to examine his surroundings with his torch.
Inspector Armadale, taking advantage of the space thus made clear,
crept into the tiny chamber.

“This place looks as if it had been washed out, lately,” he said,
examining the smooth flagstones which formed the floor. He turned his
attention to the roof, evidently in search of dripping water; but he
could find none, though the walls were moist.

Suddenly Sir Clinton bent forward and brought his lamp near something
on the side of the niche.

The Inspector, seeing something in the patch of light, craned forward
to look also, and as he did so he seemed to recognize what he saw.

“Why, that’s . . .” he ejaculated.

Sir Clinton’s lamp went out abruptly, and Inspector Armadale felt his
arm gripped warningly in the darkness.

“Sorry,” the Chief Constable apologized. “My finger must have shifted
the switch on the torch. Out of the way, Inspector, please. There’s
nothing more to be seen here.”

Inspector Armadale wriggled back into the passage again as Sir Clinton
made a movement as though to come out of his perch in the recess.

“So this is where Maurice got to when he left the museum?” the Chief
Constable said, reflectively. “Well, he isn’t here now, that’s plain.
We’ll need to look elsewhere, Inspector, according to your scheme. If
he wasn’t elsewhere he was to be here. But as he isn’t here he’s
obviously elsewhere. And now I think we’ll make our way up to the
museum again. Wait a moment! We’ve got to get back into that passage
with our heads in the right direction. Once we’re into the tunnel
there won’t be room to turn round.”

It took some manœuvring to arrange this, for the tiny chamber was a
tight fit for even three men; but at last they succeeded in getting
back into the tunnel in a position which permitted them to creep
forwards instead of backwards. They finally accomplished the long
journey without incident, and emerged through the gaping panel into
the museum once more.

“Now we’ll turn our backs again, Inspector, and let Mr. Chacewater
close the panel.”

Again the sharp click notified them that they could turn round. The
panelling seemed completely solid.

“There are just a couple of points I’d like to know about,” Sir
Clinton said, turning to Cecil. “You don’t know the combination that
opens the safe over there, I believe?”

Cecil Chacewater seemed both surprised and relieved to hear this
question.

“No,” he said. “Maurice kept the combination to himself.”

Sir Clinton nodded as though he had expected this answer.

“Just another point,” he continued. “You may not be able to remember
this. At any time after you and Foxton Polegate had planned that
practical joke of yours, did Foss ask you the time?”

Cecil was obviously completely taken aback by this query.

“Did he ask me the time? Not that I know of. I can’t remember his ever
doing that. Wait a bit, though. No, he didn’t.”

Sir Clinton seemed disappointed for a moment. Then, evidently, a fresh
idea occurred to him.

“On the night of the masked ball, did any one ask you the time?”

Cecil considered for a moment or two.

“Now I come to think of it, a fellow dressed as a cow-boy came up and
said his watch had stopped.”

“Ah! I thought so,” was all Sir Clinton replied, much to the vexation
of Inspector Armadale.

“By the way,” the Chief Constable went on, “I’d rather like to get to
the top of one of those turrets up above.” He made a gesture
indicating the roof. “There’s a stair, isn’t there?”

Armadale had difficulty in concealing his surprise at this unexpected
demand. Cecil Chacewater made no difficulties, but led them upstairs
and opened the door of the entrance to a turret. When they reached an
open space at the summit, Sir Clinton leaned on the parapet and gazed
over the surrounding country with interest. As the space was
restricted, Cecil remained within the turret, at the top of the stair;
but the Inspector joined his Chief on the platform.

“Splendid view, isn’t it, Inspector?”

“Yes, sir. Very fine.”

Armadale was evidently puzzled by this turn of affairs. He could not
see why Sir Clinton should have come up to admire the view instead of
getting on with the investigation. The Chief Constable did not seem to
notice his subordinate’s perplexity.

“There’s Hincheldene,” Sir Clinton pointed out. “With a decent pair of
glasses one could read the time on the clock-tower on a clear day.
These woods round about give a restful look to things. Soothing, that
greenery. Ah! Just follow my finger, Inspector. See that white thing
over yonder? That’s one of these Fairy Houses.”

He searched here and there in the landscape for a moment.

“There’s another of them, just where you see that stream running
across the opening between the two spinneys—yonder. And there’s a
third one, not far off that ruined tower. See it? I wonder if we could
pick up any more. They seem to be thick enough on the ground. Yes, see
that one in the glade over there? Not see it? Look at that grey
cottage with the creeper on it; two o’clock; three fingers. See it
now?”

“I can’t quite make it out, sir,” the Inspector confessed.

He seemed bored by Sir Clinton’s insistence on the matter; but he held
up his hand and tried to discover the object. After a moment or two he
gave up the attempt and, turning round, he noticed his Chief slipping
a small compass into his pocket.

“Quite worth seeing, that view,” Sir Clinton remarked, imperturbably,
as he made his way towards the turret stair. “Thanks very much, Cecil.
I don’t think we need trouble you any more for the present; but I’d
like to see your sister, if she’s available. I want to ask her a
question.”

Cecil Chacewater went in search of Joan, and after a few minutes she
met them at the foot of the stair.

“There’s just one point that occurred to me since you told us about
that interview you and Maurice had with Foss before you went to the
museum. You were sitting on the terrace, weren’t you?”

“Yes,” Joan confirmed.

“Then you must have seen Foss’s car drive up when it came to wait at
the front door for him?”

“I remember seeing it come up just before we went to the museum. I
didn’t say anything about it before. It didn’t seem to matter much.”

“That was quite natural,” Sir Clinton reassured her. “In fact, I’m not
sure that it matters much even yet. I’m just trying for any evidence I
can get. Tell me anything whatever that you noticed, no matter whether
it seems important or not.”

Joan thought for almost a minute before replying.

“I did notice the chauffeur putting the hood up, and I wondered what
on earth he was doing that for on a blazing day.”

“Anything else?”

“He had his tool-kit out and seemed to be going to do some repair or
other.”

“At the moment when he’d brought the car round for Foss?” demanded the
Inspector, rather incredulously. “Surely he’d have everything spick
and span before he left the garage?”

“You’d better ask him about it, himself, Inspector,” said Joan,
tartly. “I’m merely telling what I saw; and I saw that plain enough.
Besides, he may have known he’d plenty of time. Mr. Foss was going
away with us and obviously he wasn’t in a hurry to use the car.”

Sir Clinton ignored the Inspector’s interruption.

“I’ve got my own car at the door,” he observed. “Perhaps you could go
out on to the terrace and direct me while I bring it into the same
position as you saw Foss’s car that afternoon.”

Joan agreed; and they went down together.

“Now,” said Sir Clinton as he started the engine, “would you mind
directing me?”

Joan, from the terrace, indicated how he was to manœuvre until he had
brought his own car into a position as near as possible to that
occupied by Foss’s car on the afternoon of the murder.

“That’s as near as I can get it,” she said at last.

Sir Clinton turned in his seat and scanned the front of Ravensthorpe.

“What window is this that I’m opposite?” he inquired.

“That’s the window of the museum,” Joan explained. “But you can’t see
into the room, can you? You’re too low down there.”

“Nothing more than the tops of the cases,” Sir Clinton said. “You’d
better get aboard, Inspector. There’s nothing more to do here.”

He waved good-bye to Joan as Armadale stepped into the car, and then
drove down the avenue. The Inspector said nothing until they had
passed out of the Ravensthorpe grounds and were on the high road
again. Then he turned eagerly to the Chief Constable.

“That was a splash of blood you found on the wall of the underground
room, wasn’t it? I recognized it at once.”

“Don’t get excited about it, Inspector,” said Sir Clinton soothingly.
“Of course it was blood; but we needn’t shout about it from the
house-tops, need we?”

Armadale thought he detected a tacit reproof for his exclamation at
the time the discovery was made.

“You covered up that word or two of mine very neatly, sir,” he
admitted frankly. “I was startled when I saw that spot of blood on the
wall, and I nearly blurted it out. Silly of me to do it, I suppose.
But you managed to smother it up with that bungling with your lamp
before I’d given anything away. I’d no notion you wanted to keep the
thing quiet.”

“No harm done,” Sir Clinton reassured him. “But be careful another
time. One needn’t show all one’s cards.”

“You certainly don’t,” Armadale retorted.

“Well, you have all the facts, Inspector. What more do you expect?”

Armadale thought it best to change the subject.

“That water that we saw down there,” he went on. “That never leaked in
through the roof. The masonry overhead was as tight as a drum and
there wasn’t a sign of drip-marks anywhere. That water came from
somewhere else. Some one had been washing up in that cellar. There had
been more blood there—lots of it; and they’d washed it away. That tiny
patch was a bit they’d overlooked. Isn’t that so, sir?”

“That’s an inference and not a fact, Inspector,” Sir Clinton pointed
out, with an expression approaching to a grin on his face. “I don’t
say you’re wrong. In fact, I’m sure you’re right. But only facts are
supposed to go into the common stock, remember.”

“Very good, sir.”

But the Inspector had something in reserve.

“I’ll give you a fact now,” he said with ill-suppressed triumph. “As
you came away, you happened to ask Mr. Chacewater if he’d come by the
first train this morning.”

“Yes.”

“And he said he did?”

“Yes.”

“Well,” said Armadale, with a tinge of derision in his voice, “he took
you in, there; but he didn’t come over me with that tale. He didn’t
come by the first train; he wasn’t in it! And what’s more, he didn’t
come by train to our station at all, for I happened to make inquiries.
I knew you were anxious for him to come back, and I thought I’d ask
whether he’d come.”

“That’s very interesting,” said Sir Clinton.

He made no further remark until they reached the police station. Then,
as they got out of the car, he turned to the Inspector.

“Care to see me do a little map-drawing, Inspector? It might amuse
you.”



CHAPTER XII

Chuchundra’s Body

Sir Clinton’s map-drawing, however, was destined to be postponed.
Hardly had they entered his office when the telephone bell rang. After
a few moments’ conversation he put down the receiver and turned to
Armadale.

“That’s Mold, the keeper. He’s found Maurice Chacewater’s body. He’s
telephoning from his own cottage, so I told him to wait there and
we’ll go up in the car. The body’s in the woods and we’ll save time by
getting Mold to guide us to it instead of hunting round for the
place.”

It did not take long to reach the head keeper’s cottage, where they
found Mold in a state of perturbation.

“Where is this body?” Sir Clinton demanded, cutting short Mold’s
rather confused attempts to explain matters. “Take us to it first of
all and then I’ll ask what I want to know.”

Under the keeper’s guidance they made their way through the woods, and
at last emerged into a small clearing in the centre of which rose a
few ruined walls.

“This is what they call the Knight’s Tower,” Armadale explained.

Sir Clinton nodded.

“I expected something of the sort. Now, Mold, where’s Mr. Chacewater’s
body?”

The keeper led them round the Tower, and as they turned the corner of
a wall they came upon the body stretched at full length on the grass.

“The turf’s short,” said Armadale, with some disappointment. “There’s
no track on it round about here.”

“That’s true,” said Sir Clinton. “We’ll have to do without that help.”

He walked over to where Maurice Chacewater was lying. The body was on
its back; and a glance at the head was enough to show that life must
be extinct.

“It’s not pretty,” Sir Clinton said as he pulled out his handkerchief
and covered the dead face. “Shot at close range, evidently. I don’t
wonder you were a bit upset, Mold.”

He glanced round the little glade, then turned again to the keeper.

“When did you find him?” he demanded.

“Just before I rang you up, sir. As soon as I came across him, I ran
off to my cottage and telephoned to you.”

“When were you over this ground last?—before you found him, I mean.”

“Just before dusk, last night, sir. He wasn’t there, then.”

“You’re sure?”

“Certain, sir. I couldn’t have missed seeing him.”

“You haven’t touched the body?”

Mold shuddered slightly.

“No, sir. I went off at once and rang you up.”

“You met no one hereabouts this morning?”

“No, sir.”

“And you saw no one last night, either?”

“No, sir.”

“It was somewhere round about here, wasn’t it, that you heard that
mysterious shot you told us about?”

“Yes, sir. I was just here at the time.”

Mold walked about twenty yards past the tower, to show the exact
position. Sir Clinton studied the lie of the land for a moment.

“H’m! Have you any questions you want to ask, Inspector?”

Armadale considered for a moment or two.

“You’re sure you haven’t moved this body in any way?” he demanded.

“I never put a finger on it,” Mold asserted.

“And it’s lying just as it was when you saw it first?” Armadale
pursued.

“As near as I can remember,” Mold replied, cautiously. “I didn’t wait
long after I saw it. I went off almost at once to ring up the police.”

Armadale seemed to have got all the information he expected. Sir
Clinton, seeing that no more questions were to come, turned to the
keeper.

“Go off to the house and tell Mr. Cecil Chacewater that his brother’s
found and that he’s to come here at once. You needn’t say anything
about the matter to any one else. They’ll hear soon enough. And when
you’ve done that, ring up the police station and tell them to send up
a sergeant and a couple of constables to me here. Hurry, now.”

Mold went without a word. Sir Clinton waited till he was out of
earshot and then glanced at Armadale.

“One thing stares you in the face,” the Inspector said in answer to
the look. “He wasn’t shot here. That wound would mean any amount of
blood; and there’s hardly any blood on the grass.”

Sir Clinton’s face showed his agreement. He looked down at the body.

“He’s lying on his back now; but after he was shot he lay on his left
side till _rigor mortis_ set in,” he pointed out.

The Inspector examined the body carefully.

“I think I see how you get that,” he said. “This left arm’s off the
ground a trifle. If he’d been shot here and fell in this position, the
arm would have relaxed and followed the lie of the ground. Is that
it?”

“Yes, that and the hypostases. You see the marks on the left side of
the face.”

“A dead man doesn’t shift himself,” the Inspector observed with an
oracular air. “Some one else must have had a motive for dragging him
about.”

“Here’s a revolver,” Sir Clinton pointed out, picking it up gingerly
to avoid marking it with finger-prints. “You can see, later on, if
anything’s to be made out from it.”

He put the revolver carefully down on a part of the ruined wall near
at hand and then returned to the body.

“To judge by the _rigor mortis_,” he said, after making a test, “he
must have been dead for a good while—a dozen hours or more.”

“What about that shot that the keeper said he heard?” queried
Armadale.

“The time might fit well enough. But _rigor mortis_ is no real
criterion, you know, Inspector. It varies too much from case to case.”

Inspector Armadale pulled out a small magnifying glass and examined
the dead man’s hand carefully.

“Those were his finger-prints on that Japanese sword right enough,
sir,” he pointed out. “You can see that tiny scar on the thumb quite
plainly if you look.”

He held out the glass, and Sir Clinton inspected the right thumb of
the body minutely.

“I didn’t doubt it from the evidence you had before, Inspector; but
this certainly clinches it. The scar’s quite clear.”

“Shall I go through the pockets now?” Armadale asked.

“You may as well,” Sir Clinton agreed.

Inspector Armadale began by putting his fingers into the body’s
waistcoat pocket. As he did so his face showed his surprise.

“Hullo! Here’s something!”

He pulled out the object and held it up for Sir Clinton’s inspection.

“One of the Leonardo medallions,” Sir Clinton said, as soon as he had
identified the thing. “Let me have a closer look at it, Inspector.”

He examined the edge with care.

“This seems to be the genuine article, Inspector. I can’t see any hole
in the edge, which they told me was drilled to distinguish the
replicas from the real thing. No, there’s no mark of any sort here.”

He handed it back to the Inspector, who examined it in his turn. Sir
Clinton took it back when the Inspector had done with it, and placed
it in his pocket.

“I think, Inspector, we’ll say nothing about this find for the
present. I’ve an idea it may be a useful thing to have up our sleeve
before we’ve done. By the way, do you still connect Foxton Polegate
with this case?”

Armadale looked the Chief Constable in the eye as he replied.

“I’m more inclined to connect Cecil Chacewater with it, just now, sir.
Look at the facts. It’s been common talk that there was ill-feeling
between those two brothers. Servants talk; and other people repeat it.
And the business that ended in the final row between the two of them
was centred in these Leonardo medallions. That’s worth thinking over.
Then, again, Cecil Chacewater disappeared for a short while. You
couldn’t get in touch with him. And it was just at that time that
queer things began to happen here at Ravensthorpe. Where was he then?
It seems a bit suggestive, doesn’t it? And where was he last night? If
you looked at him this morning, you couldn’t help seeing he’d spent a
queer night, wherever he spent it. That was the night when this body
was brought here from wherever the shooting was done. And when you
asked Cecil Chacewater how he’d come home, he said he’d arrived by the
first train this morning. That was a lie. He didn’t come by that
train. He’d been here before that.”

To the Inspector’s amazement and disgust Sir Clinton laughed
unaffectedly at this exposition.

“It’s nothing to laugh at, sir. You can’t deny these things. I don’t
say they prove anything; but you can’t brush them aside by merely
laughing at them. They’ve got to be explained. And until they’ve been
explained in some satisfactory way things will look very fishy.”

Sir Clinton recovered his serious mask.

“Perhaps I laughed a little too soon, Inspector. I apologize. I’m not
absolutely certain of my ground; I quite admit that. But I’ll just
give you one hint. Sometimes one case looks as if it were two
independent affairs. Sometimes two independent affairs get interlocked
and look like one case. Now just think that over carefully. It’s
perhaps got the germ of something in it, if you care to fish it out.”

“Half of what you’ve said already sounds like riddles to me, sir,”
Armadale protested, fretfully. “I’m never sure when you’re serious and
when you’re pulling my leg.”

Sir Clinton was saved from the embarrassment of a reply by the arrival
of Cecil Chacewater. He nodded curtly to the two officials as he came
up. The Inspector stepped forward to meet him.

“I’d like to put one or two questions to you, Mr. Chacewater,” he
said, ignoring the look on Sir Clinton’s face.

Cecil looked Armadale up and down before replying.

“Well, go on,” he said, shortly.

“First of all, Mr. Chacewater,” the Inspector began, “I want to know
when you last saw your brother alive.”

Cecil replied without the slightest hesitation:

“On the morning I left Ravensthorpe. We’d had a disagreement and I
left the house.”

“That was the last time you saw him?”

“No. I see him now.”

The Inspector looked up angrily from his notebook.

“You’re giving the impression of quibbling, Mr. Chacewater.”

“I’m answering your questions, Inspector, to the best of my ability.”

Armadale made a fresh cast.

“Where did you go when you left Ravensthorpe?”

“To London.”

“You’ve been in London, then, until this morning?”

Cecil paused for a moment or two before answering.

“May I ask, Inspector, whether you’re bringing any charge against me?
If you are, then I believe you ought to caution me. If you aren’t,
then I don’t propose to answer your questions. Now, what are you going
to do about it?”

Armadale was hardly prepared for this move.

“I think you’re injudicious, Mr. Chacewater,” he said in a tone which
he was evidently striving not to make threatening. “I know you didn’t
arrive by the first train this morning, though you told us you did.
Your position’s rather an awkward one, if you think about it.”

“You can’t bluff me, Inspector,” Cecil returned. “Make your charge,
and I’ll know how to answer it. If you won’t make a charge, I don’t
propose to help you with a fishing inquiry.”

The Inspector glanced at Sir Clinton’s face, and on it he read quite
plainly the Chief Constable’s disapproval of his proceedings. He
decided to go no further for the moment. Sir Clinton intervened to
make the situation less strained.

“Would you mind looking at him, Cecil, and formally identifying him?”

Cecil came forward rather reluctantly, knelt down beside his brother’s
body, examined the clothes, and finally, removing the handkerchief,
gazed for a moment or two at the shattered face. The shot had entered
the right side of the head and had done enough damage to show that it
had been fired almost in contact with the skin.

Cecil replaced the handkerchief and rose to his feet. For a few
moments he stood looking down at the body. Then he turned away.

“That’s my brother, undoubtedly.”

Then, as if speaking to himself, he added in a regretful tone:

“Poor old Chuchundra!”

To the Inspector’s amazement Sir Clinton started a little at the word.

“Was that a nickname, Cecil?”

Cecil looked up, and the Inspector could see that he was more than a
little moved.

“We used to call him that when we were kids.”

Sir Clinton’s next question left the Inspector still further bemused.

“Out of ‘The Jungle Book’ by any chance?”

Cecil seemed to see the drift of the inquiry, for he replied at once:

“Yes. _Rikki-tikki-tavi_, you know.”

“I was almost certain of it,” said Sir Clinton. “I can put a name to
the trouble, I think. It begins with A.”

Cecil reflected for a moment before replying.

“Yes. You’re right. It does begin with A.”

“That saves a lot of bother,” said Sir Clinton, thankfully. “I was
just going to fish in a fresh direction to get that bit of
information. I’m quite satisfied now.”

Cecil seemed to pay little attention to the Chief Constable’s last
remark. His eyes went round to the shattered thing that had been his
brother.

“I’d no notion it was as bad as all this,” he said, more to himself
than to the others. “If I’d known, I wouldn’t have been so bitter
about things.”

The sergeant and constables appeared at the edge of the clearing.

“Seen all you want to see, Inspector?” asked Sir Clinton. “Then in
that case we can leave the body in charge of the sergeant. I see
they’ve got a stretcher with them. They can take it down to
Ravensthorpe.”

Armadale rapidly gave the necessary orders to his subordinates.

“Now, Inspector, I think we’ll go over to Ravensthorpe ourselves. I
want to see that chauffeur again. Something’s occurred to me.”

As the three men walked through the belt of woodland Sir Clinton
turned to Cecil.

“There’s one point I’d like to have cleared up. Do you know if Maurice
had any visitors in the last three months or so—people who wanted to
see the collection?”

Cecil reflected for a time before he could recall the facts.

“Now you mention it, I remember hearing Maurice say something about a
fellow—a Yankee—who was writing a book on Leonardo. That chap
certainly came here one day and Maurice showed him the stuff. The
medallions were what he chiefly wanted to look at, of course.”

“You didn’t see him?”

“No. None of us saw him except Maurice.”

Sir Clinton made no comment; and they walked on in silence till they
came to the house. Inspector Armadale was by this time completely at
sea.

“Find that chauffeur, Inspector, please; and bring him along. I’ve got
one or two points which need clearing up.”

When the chauffeur arrived it was evident that Armadale had not been
mistaken when he described him as stupid-looking. Information had to
be dragged out of him by minute questioning.

“Your name’s Brackley, isn’t it?” Sir Clinton began.

“Yes, sir. Joe Brackley.”

“Now, Brackley, don’t be in a hurry with your replies. I want you to
think carefully. First of all, on the day that Mr. Foss was murdered,
he ordered you to bring the car round to the front door.”

“Yes, sir. I was to wait for him if he wasn’t there.”

“You pulled up the car here, didn’t you?”

Sir Clinton indicated the position in front of the house.

“Yes, sir. It was there or thereabouts.”

“Then you put up the hood?”

“Yes, sir.”

“What possessed you to do that on a sunny day?”

“One of the fastenings was a bit loose and I wanted to make it right
before going out.”

“You didn’t think of doing that in the garage?”

“I didn’t notice it, sir, until I’d brought the car round. My eye
happened to fall on it. And just then I saw Mr. Foss going off into
the house with some people. He didn’t seem in a hurry, so I thought
I’d just time to make the repair before he came out.”

“You got on to the running-board to reach the hood, didn’t you?”

“Yes, sir.”

“Which running-board? The one nearest the house?”

“No, sir. The other one.”

“So you could see the front of the house as you were working?”

“Yes, sir.”

“Did you see anything—anything whatever—while you were at work? You
must have raised your eyes occasionally.”

“I could see the window opposite me.”

“By and by, I think, Marden, the valet, came up and spoke to you?”

“Yes, sir, he did. He’d been going to the post, he said, but there had
been some mistake or other and he’d come back.”

“He left you and went into the house?”

“Yes, sir.”

“After that, did you see Marden again—I mean within, say, twenty
minutes or so?”

“Yes, sir.”

“Where did you see him, if you can remember?”

“Up there, sir, at that window. He was talking to Mr. Foss.”

“When you were up on the running-board, you could just see into the
room?”

“Yes, sir.”

“What happened after that?”

“I finished the repair; so I came down off the running-board and let
down the hood again.”

“Anything else you can remember, Brackley?”

“No, sir.”

“Very well. That will do. By the way, Inspector,” Sir Clinton turned
round, preventing the Inspector from making any comments while the
chauffeur was standing by, “I’d clean forgotten the patrolling of the
place up yonder. I’ve never found time to go up there; but it’s really
a bit out of date now. I think we can dispense with the patrol after
to-night. And the same holds for that guard on the museum. There’s no
need for either of them.”

“Very good, sir,” Armadale responded, mechanically.

The Inspector was engaged in condemning his own stupidity. Why had he
not seen the possibilities involved in that repair of the hood? With
the extra foot of elevation of course the chauffeur could see further
into the museum than a man standing on the ground. And here was the
damning evidence that Marden’s story was a lie. And the Inspector had
missed it. He almost gritted his teeth in vexation as he thought of
it. The keystone of the case: and the Chief Constable had taken it
under his nose!

Sir Clinton turned to Cecil as the chauffeur retired.

“I shall be here about one o’clock in the morning, Cecil,” he said,
lowering his voice. “I want you to be on the watch and let me in
without any one getting wind of my visit. Can you manage it?”

“Easily enough.”

“Very well. I’ll be at the door at one o’clock sharp. But remember,
it’s an absolutely hush-hush affair. There must be no noise of any
sort.”

“I’ll see to that,” Cecil assured him.

Sir Clinton turned to the Inspector.

“Now I think we’ll go across to where we left my car.”

On the way to the police station Sir Clinton’s manner did not
encourage conversation; but as they got out of the car he turned to
Armadale.

“Map-drawing’s a bit late in the day now, Inspector; but we may as
well carry on for the sake of completeness.”

He led the way to his office, took a ruler and protractor from his
desk, and set to work on a sheet of paper.

“Take this point as the museum,” he said. “This line represents the
beginning of the tunnel. I took the bearing that time when I lagged
behind you. At the next turn—this one here—I made a pretence of
examining the walls and took the bearing as we were standing there. I
got the third bearing when I asked you to measure the dimensions of
the tunnel. As it has turned out, secrecy wasn’t really necessary; but
it seemed just as well to keep the survey to ourselves. I got the
distances by pacing, except the last bit. There I had to estimate it,
since we were crawling on all fours; but I think I got it near
enough.”

“And you carried all the figures in your memory?”

“Yes. I’ve a fairly good memory when I’m put to it.”

“You must have,” said Armadale, frankly.

“Now,” Sir Clinton went on. “By drawing in these lines we get the
position of that underground room. It’s here, you see. The next thing
is to find out where it lies, relative to the ground surface. I had a
fair notion; so when I got to the top of the turret I took the bearing
of the Knight’s Tower. I’ll just rule it in. You see the two lines cut
quite near the cell. My notion is that there’s a second entrance into
that tunnel from that ruined tower. In the old days it may have been a
secret road into the outpost tower when a siege was going on.”

“I see what you’re getting at now,” Armadale interrupted. “You mean
that Maurice Chacewater’s body was in the cell and that it was shifted
from there up the other secret passage—the one we didn’t see—and left
alongside the tower this morning?”

“Something of that sort.”

“And now we’ve got to find who killed Maurice Chacewater down there,
underground?”

“There’s nothing in that, Inspector. He killed himself. It’s a fairly
plain case of suicide.”

“But why did he commit suicide?”

Sir Clinton appeared suddenly smitten with deafness. He ignored the
Inspector’s last inquiry completely.

“I shall want you to-night, Inspector. Come to my house at about
half-past twelve. And you had better wear rubber-soled boots or tennis
shoes if you have them. We’ll go up to Ravensthorpe in my car.”

“You’re going to arrest Marden, sir?”

“No,” was Sir Clinton’s reply, which took the Inspector completely
aback. “I’m not going to arrest anybody. I’m going to show you what
Foss was going to do with his otophone; that’s all.”



CHAPTER XIII

The Otophone

Punctually at half-past twelve the Inspector arrived at Sir Clinton’s
house. The Chief Constable’s first glance was at the feet of his
subordinate.

“Tennis shoes? That’s right. Now, Inspector, I want you to understand
clearly that silence is absolutely essential when we get to work.
We’ll need to take a leaf out of the book of the ‘Pirates of
Penzance’:

    With cat-like tread
    Upon our prey we steal.

That’s our model, if you please. The car’s outside. We’ll go at once.”

As preparations for an important raid, these remarks seemed to
Armadale hardly adequate; but as Sir Clinton showed no desire to
amplify them, the Inspector was left to puzzle over the immediate
future without assistance. The hint about the otophone had roused his
curiosity.

“Foss’s hearing was quite normal,” he said to himself, turning the
evidence over in his mind. “He heard that conversation in the
winter-garden quite clearly enough. So quite evidently one couldn’t
call him deaf. And yet he was dragging an otophone about with him. I
don’t see it.”

The Chief Constable pulled up the car in the avenue at a considerable
distance from the house.

“Change here for Ravensthorpe,” he explained, opening the door beside
him. “I can’t take the motor nearer for fear of the engine’s noise
giving us away.”

He glanced at the illuminated clock on the dashboard.

“We’re in nice time,” he commented. “Come along, Inspector; and the
less said the better.”

They reached the door of Ravensthorpe exactly at one o’clock. Cecil
was waiting for them on the threshold.

“Switch off those lights,” Sir Clinton said in a whisper, pointing to
the hall lights which Cecil had left burning. “We mustn’t give the
show away if we can help it. Some one might be looking out of a window
and be tempted to come down and turn them out. You’re supposed to be
in bed, aren’t you?”

Cecil nodded without speaking, and, crossing the hall, he extinguished
the lamps. Sir Clinton pulled an electric torch from his pocket.

“There’s a staircase giving access to the servant’s quarters, isn’t
there?”

Cecil confirmed this, and Sir Clinton turned to the Inspector.

“Which of your men is on duty at the museum door to-night?”

“Froggatt,” the Inspector answered.

“We’ll go along to him,” said Sir Clinton. “I want you, Cecil, to take
the constable and post him at the bottom of that stair. Here’s the
flash-lamp.”

Froggatt was surprised to see the party.

“Now, Froggatt,” the Chief Constable directed. “You’re to go with Mr.
Chacewater. He’ll show you where to stand. All you have to do is to
stick to your post there until you’re relieved. It’ll only be a matter
of ten minutes or so. Don’t make the slightest sound unless anything
goes wrong. Your business is to prevent any one getting down the
stair. There’ll be no trouble. If you see any one, just shout: ‘Who’s
there?’ That’ll be quite enough.”

The Inspector and Sir Clinton waited on the threshold of the museum
until Cecil came back.

“Very convenient having these museum lights on all night,” Sir Clinton
remarked. “We don’t need to muddle about with the flash-lamp. Now just
wait here for a moment, and don’t speak a word. I’m going upstairs.”

He ascended to the first floor, entered Foss’s room and picked up the
otophone, with which he returned to his companions.

“Now we can get to work,” he whispered, leading the way into the
museum. “Just lock that door behind us, Inspector.”

Followed by the other two he stepped across the museum to the bay
containing the safe. There he put the otophone on the floor and opened
the case of the instrument. From one compartment he took an ear-phone
with its head-band. A moment’s search revealed the position of the
connection, and he plugged the ear-phone wire into place in sockets
let into the outside of the attaché case. A little further examination
revealed a stud beside the leather handle, and this Sir Clinton
pressed.

“That should start the thing,” he commented.

He lifted the hinged metal plate slightly and peered into the cavity
which contained the valves.

“That seems all right,” he said, as his eye caught the faint glow of
the dull emitters.

Shutting down the plate again, the Chief Constable put his finger into
the compartment from which he had taken the ear-phone, pressed a
concealed spring, and pulled up the floor of the compartment.

“This is the microphone,” he explained, drawing out a thick ebonite
disk mounted on the false bottom of the compartment. “It’s attached to
a longish wire so that you can take it out and put it on a table while
the case with the valves and batteries lies on the floor out of the
way. Now we’ll tune up.”

He brought microphone and ear-phone together, when a faint musical
note made itself heard. Then he handed the microphone to Cecil.

“Hold that tight against the safe door, Cecil. Get the base in contact
with the metal of the safe and keep the microphone face downwards.
It’s essential to hold it absolutely steady, for the slightest
vibration will put me off.”

He fitted on the head-band and moved the two tiny levers of the
otophone until the adjustment of the instrument seemed to satisfy him.
Then, very cautiously, he began to work the mechanism of the
combination lock. For some time he seemed unable to get what he
wanted; but suddenly he made a slight gesture of triumph.

“It’s an old pattern, as I thought. There’s no balanced fence arbour.
This is going to be an easy business.”

Easy or not, it took him nearly a quarter of an hour to accomplish his
task; for at times he obviously went astray in the work.

“Try to keep your feet still,” he said. “Every movement you make is
magnified up to the noise of a pocket avalanche.”

At last the thing was done. The safe door swung open. Sir Clinton took
off the head-band, received the microphone from Cecil, and packed it
away in the case of the otophone along with the ear-phone.

“You’d better jot down the number of the combination, Cecil,” he
suggested. “It’s on the dial at present.”

While Cecil was busy with this, the Chief Constable switched off the
otophone and put it in a place of safety.

“Now we’ll see what’s inside the safe,” he said.

He swung the door full open and disclosed a cavity more like a
strong-room than a safe.

“Have you any idea where the medallions were usually kept?” he
inquired.

Cecil went over to one of the shelves and searched rapidly.

“Why, there are only two of them here!” he exclaimed in dismay.

“Hush!” Sir Clinton warned him sharply. “Don’t make a row. Have a good
look at the things.”

Cecil picked up the medallions and scanned them minutely. His face
showed his amazement as he turned from one to another.

“These are the replicas! Where have the genuine Leonardos gone?”

“Never mind that for the present. Put these things back again. I’m
going to close the safe. We mustn’t risk talking too much here; and
the sooner we’re gone the better.”

He picked up the otophone and led the way out of the museum.

“You might bring Froggatt back to his post here,” he said. “We don’t
need him at the stair any longer. I must go upstairs again for a
moment with this machine.”

Cecil piloted Froggatt back to his original post just as the Chief
Constable rejoined them.

“I don’t want to talk here,” Sir Clinton said to Cecil. “Get a coat
and walk with us down to the car. We’ve done our work for the night.”

The Chief Constable waited until they were well away from the house
before beginning his explanation.

“That otophone is—as I expect you saw—simply a microphone for picking
up sound, plus a two-valve amplifier for magnifying it. The sounds
that reach the microphone are amplified by the valves set to any
extent, within limits, that you like to set it for. You can make the
crumpling of a piece of paper sound like a small thunderstorm if you
choose; and it’s especially sensitive to clicks and sounds of that
sort. The mere involuntary shifting of your feet on that parquet floor
made a lot of disturbance.

“Now in the older type of combination locks, if the dial was carefully
manipulated, a person with sharp hearing might just be able to detect
a faint click when a tumbler fell into place in the course of a
circuit; and by making a note of the state of the dial corresponding
to each click the combination could finally be discovered. In the
modern patterns of locks this has been got round. They’ve introduced a
thing called a balanced fence arbour, which is lifted away from the
tumblers as soon as the lock spindle is revolved; so in this new
pattern there’s no clicking such as the older locks give.”

“I see now,” said the Inspector. “That’s an old pattern lock; and you
were using the otophone to magnify the sound of the clicks?”

“Exactly,” Sir Clinton agreed. “It made the thing mere child’s play.
Each click sounded like a whip-crack, almost.”

“So that’s why Foss brought the otophone along? He meant to pick the
lock of the safe and get the medallions out of it?”

“That was one possibility, of course,” Sir Clinton said, with a grave
face. “But I shouldn’t like to say that it was the only possibility.”

He smoked for a few moments in silence, then he turned to Cecil.

“Now I’ve a piece of work for you to do; and I want you to do it
convincingly. First thing to-morrow morning you’re to find some way of
spreading the news that you’ve recovered all the genuine medallions
and that they’re in the safe. Don’t give any details; but see that the
yarn gets well abroad.”

“But all the real medallions are gone!” said Cecil in disgust. “And
whoever’s got them must know they’re gone.”

“There’s nothing like a good authoritative lie for shaking
confidence,” Sir Clinton observed, mildly. “That’s your share in the
business. You’d better mention it at breakfast time to as many people
as you can; and you can telephone the glad news to me, with the door
of the telephone box open so that any one can hear it. Yell as loud as
you please, or louder if possible. It won’t hurt me at the other end.
In any case, see that the happy tidings wash the most distant shores.”

“Well, since you say so, I’ll do it. But it’s sure to be found out,
you know, sooner or later.”

“All I want is a single day’s run of it. My impression is that, if
things go well, I’ll have the whole Ravensthorpe affair cleared up by
this time to-morrow. But I don’t promise that as a certainty.”

“And this yarn is part of your scheme?”

“I’m setting a trap,” Sir Clinton assured them. “And that lie is the
bait I’m offering.”

As they reached the car, he added:

“See that your constable doesn’t say a word about this affair
to-night—to any one. That’s important, Inspector.”



CHAPTER XIV

The Second Chase in the Woods

“I’ve made all the necessary arrangements, sir,” Inspector Armadale
reported to the Chief Constable on the following evening. “A dozen
constables—two with rubber-soled shoes—and a couple of sergeants.
They’re to be at the Ravensthorpe gate immediately it’s dark enough.
The sergeants have the instructions; the constables don’t even know
where they’re going when they leave here.”

“That’s correct,” Sir Clinton confirmed. “Let’s see. That’s fourteen
altogether. Less two, twelve. Plus you and myself, fourteen. I think
we’ll add to our number. Nothing like being on the safe side. Mr.
Chacewater’s personally interested in the affair; I think we’ll take
him in also. And Mr. Clifton might reasonably claim some share in the
business. That makes sixteen. You’re detaching two constables to watch
that lakelet. Well, surely fourteen of us ought to be able to pick up
the scoundrel without difficulty.”

“You’re sure that he’ll make for the terrace over the pool, sir?”

“Nothing’s sure in this world, Inspector. But I think there’s a fair
chance that he’ll make in that direction. And if he doesn’t, why,
then, we can run him down wherever he goes.”

“If he goes up there, we’ll have him,” the Inspector affirmed.
“There’ll be no amateur bungling this time, like the last affair. I’ll
see to that myself. He won’t slip through a constabulary cordon as he
did when he’d only a lot of excited youngsters to deal with.”

“I leave that part of the business entirely in your hands, Inspector,”
the Chief Constable assured him.

“What I can’t see,” the Inspector continued, with a faint
querulousness in his tone, “is why you’re going about the thing in
this elaborate way. Why not arrest him straight off and be done with
it?”

“Because there’s one little party you’ve omitted to take into your
calculations, Inspector—and that’s the jury. Suspicion’s not good
enough for us at this stage. Criminal trials aren’t conducted on
romantic lines. Everything’s got to be proved up to the hilt. Frankly,
in this case, you’ve been scattering your suspicions over a fairly
wide field, haven’t you?”

“It’s our business to be suspicious of everybody,” the Inspector
pleaded in extenuation.

“Oh, within limits, within limits, Inspector. You started by
suspecting Foxton Polegate; then you branched off to Marden; after
that you hovered a bit round Maurice Chacewater; and at the end you
were hot on Cecil Chacewater’s heels. There’s too much of the smart
reader of detective stories about that. He suspects about six of the
characters without having any real proof at all; and then when the
criminal turns up clearly in the last chapter he says: ‘Well, that
fellow was on my list of suspects.’ That style of thing’s no use in
real criminal work, where you’ve got to produce evidence and not
merely some vague suspicions.”

“You’re a bit hard, sir,” the Inspector protested.

“Well, you criticized my methods, remember. If I were to arrest the
fellow just now, I doubt if I could convince a jury of his guilt. And
they’d be quite right. It’s their business to be sceptical and insist
on definite proof. It’s that proof that I expect to get out of
to-night’s work.”

“It will be very instructive for me, sir,” Inspector Armadale
commented, with heavy irony.

“You take things too seriously,” Sir Clinton retorted, with an evident
double meaning in the phrase. “What you need, Inspector, is a touch of
fantasy. You’ll get a taste of it to-night, perhaps, unless my
calculations go far astray. Now I’m going to ring up Mr. Chacewater
and make arrangements for to-night.”

And with that he dismissed the Inspector.

Armadale retired with a grave face; but when he closed the door behind
him his expression changed considerably.

“There he was, pulling my leg again, confound him!” he reflected. “A
touch of fantasy, indeed! What’s he getting at now? And the worst of
it is I haven’t got to the bottom of the business yet myself. He’s
been quite straight in giving me all the facts. I’m sure of that. But
they seem to me just a jumble. They don’t fit together anyhow. And yet
he’s not the bluffing kind; he’s got it all fixed up in his mind; I’m
sure of that, whether he’s right or wrong. Well, we’ll see before many
hours are over.”

And with reflections like these Inspector Armadale had to content
himself until nightfall.

As they drove up to the Ravensthorpe gates the Inspector found Sir
Clinton in one of his uncommunicative moods. He seemed abstracted, and
even, as the Inspector noted with faint malice, a little anxious about
the business before them. When they reached the gates they found the
constabulary squad awaiting them. Sir Clinton got out of the car,
after running it a little way up the avenue.

“Now, the first thing you’ve got to remember,” he said, addressing the
squad, “is that in no circumstances are you to make the slightest
noise until you hear my second whistle. You know what you’re to do?
Get up behind the house at the end opposite to the servants’ wing and
stay there till you get my signal. Then you’re to come out and chase
the man whom the Inspector will show you. You’re not to try to catch
him. Keep a hundred yards behind him all the time; but don’t lose
sight of him. The Inspector will give you instructions after you’ve
chased for a while. Now which of you are the two with tennis shoes?”

Two constables stepped out of the ranks. Sir Clinton took them aside
and gave them some special instructions.

“Now, you’d better get to your places,” he said, turning to the squad
again. “Remember, not a sound. I’m afraid you’ll have a long wait, but
we must take things as they come.”

As the squad was led off into the night, he moved over to where the
Inspector was standing.

“I want something out of the car,” he said. The Inspector followed him
and waited while Sir Clinton switched off the headlights and the tail
lamp. The Chief Constable felt in a locker and handed something to
Armadale.

“A pair of night-glasses, Inspector. You’ll need them. And that’s the
lot. We’d better get to our position. There’s no saying when the
fellow may begin his work.”

Rather to the mystification of the Inspector, Sir Clinton struck
across the grass instead of following the avenue up to the house.
After a fairly long walk they halted under a large tree.

“A touch of fantasy was what I recommended to you, Inspector. I think
a little tree-climbing is indicated. Sling these glasses round your
neck as I’m doing and follow on.”

“Quite mad!” was the Inspector’s involuntary comment to himself. “I
suppose, once we get up there, he’ll come down again and tell me I
needed exercise.”

He followed the Chief Constable, however; and was at last directed to
a branch on which he could find a safe seat.

“Think I’m demented, Inspector?” Sir Clinton demanded with the
accuracy of a thought-reader. “It’s not quite so bad as that, you’ll
be glad to hear. Turn your glasses through that rift in the leaves. I
was at special pains to cut it yesterday evening, in preparation for
you. What do you see?”

The Inspector focused his glasses and scanned the scene visible
through the fissure in the foliage.

“The front of Ravensthorpe,” he answered.

“Some windows?”

“Yes.”

“Well, one of them’s the window of the museum; and this happens to be
one of the few points from which you can see right into the room. If
the lights were on there, you’d find that we’re looking squarely on to
the door of the safe.”

With this help the Inspector was able to pick out the window which
evidently he was expected to watch.

“It’ll be a slow business,” Sir Clinton said in a bored tone. “But one
of us has got to keep an eye on that window for the next hour or two
at least. We can take it in turn.”

They settled down to their vigil, which proved to be a prolonged one.
The Inspector found his perch upon the branch anything but
comfortable; and it grew more wearisome as the time slipped past.

“Fantasy!” he commented bitterly to himself as he shifted his position
for the twentieth time. “Cramp’s more likely.”

But at last their tenacity was rewarded. It was during one of the
Inspector’s spells of watching. Suddenly the dark rectangle of the
window flashed into momentary illumination and faded again.

“There he is!” exclaimed the Inspector. “He’s carrying a flash-lamp.”

Sir Clinton lifted his glasses and examined the place in his turn.

“I can see him moving about in the room,” the Inspector reported
excitedly. “Now he’s going over towards the safe. Can you see him,
sir?”

“Fairly well. What do you make of him?”

The Inspector studied his quarry intently for a while.

“That’s the otophone, isn’t it, sir? I can’t see his face; it seems as
if he’d blackened it. . . . No, he’s wearing a big mask. It looks
like . . .”

His voice rose sharply.

“It’s Marden! I recognize that water-proof of his; I could swear to it
anywhere.”

“That’s quite correct, Inspector. Now I think we’ll get down from this
tree as quick as we can and I’ll blow my whistle. That ought to
startle him. And I’ve arranged for that to be the signal for a
considerable amount of noise in the house, which ought to give the
effect we want.”

He slipped lightly down the branches, waited for the slower-moving
Inspector, and then blew a single shrill blast on his whistle.

“That’s roused them,” he said, with satisfaction, as some lights
flashed up in windows on the front of Ravensthorpe. “I guess that
amount of stir about the place will flush our friend without any
trouble.”

He gazed through his glasses at the main door.

“There he goes, Inspector!”

A dark figure emerged suddenly on the threshold, hesitated for a
moment, and then ran down the steps. Armadale instinctively started
forward; but the cool voice of the Chief Constable recalled him.

“There’s no hurry, Inspector! You’d better hang your glasses on the
tree here. They’ll only hamper you in running.”

Hurriedly the Inspector obeyed; and Sir Clinton leisurely hung up his
own pair. Armadale turned again and followed the burglar with his
eyes.

“He’s making for the old quarry, sir.”

“So I see,” Sir Clinton assured him. “I want the fellow to have a good
start, remember. I don’t wish him to be pressed. Now we may as well
get the chase organized.”

Followed by the Inspector, he hurried towards the front of
Ravensthorpe.

“I think that’s a fair start to give him,” he estimated aloud. Then,
lifting his whistle, he blew a second blast.

Almost immediately the figures of Cecil Chacewater and Michael Clifton
emerged from the main door, while a few seconds later the police squad
rounded the corner of the house.

“Carry on, Inspector!” Sir Clinton advised. “I leave the rest of the
round-up to you. But keep exactly to what I told you.”

Armadale hurried off, and within a few seconds the chase had been set
afoot.

“We must see if we can wipe your eye this time, Mr. Clifton,” the
Chief Constable observed. “It’s a run over the old ground, you
notice.”

Michael Clifton nodded in answer.

“If you’d let me run him down I’d be obliged to you,” he suggested.
“You’ve given him a longish start, certainly; but I think I could pull
him in.”

Sir Clinton made a gesture of dissent.

“Oh, no. We must give him a run for his money. Besides, it wouldn’t
suit my book to have him run down too early in the game.”

The fugitive had reached the edge of the pine-wood as they were
speaking, and now he disappeared from their sight among the arcades of
the trees.

“The moon will be down in no time,” Cecil pointed out as they ran.
“Aren’t you taking the risk of losing him up in the woods there? It’ll
be pretty dark under the trees.”

He quickened his pace slightly in his eagerness; but the Chief
Constable restrained him.

“Leave it to Armadale. It’s his affair. We’re only spectators,
really.”

“I want the beggar caught,” Cecil grumbled, but he obeyed Sir
Clinton’s orders and slowed down slightly.

A few seconds brought them to the fringe of the wood; and far ahead of
them they could see the form of the burglar running steadily up the
track.

“Just the same as before?” Sir Clinton demanded from Michael.

“Just the same.”

Through the wood they went behind the police squad. At the brow of the
hill, where the trees began to thin, Armadale called a halt. They
could hear him giving orders for the formation of his cordon. When his
men began to move off under his directions the Inspector came over to
Sir Clinton.

“He’ll not slip through our hands this time, sir. I’ll beat every bit
of cover in that spinney. He can’t get away on either side without
being spotted. We’ll get our hands on him in a few minutes now. I
suppose he’s armed?”

Sir Clinton shook his head.

“I should doubt that.”

The Inspector failed to conceal his surprise.

“Not armed? He’s sure to be.”

“We’ll see in a minute or two,” the Chief Constable answered. “You’d
better get your beaters to work, hadn’t you? . . . Ah!”

In the silence they heard the sound of a faint splash from the
direction of the quarry.

“History’s repeating itself pretty accurately, isn’t it?” said Sir
Clinton, turning to Michael. “That’s the kind of thing you heard the
other night?”

“Just the same,” Michael admitted.

But as the line of constables moved forward he could not help
contrasting their methodical work with the rather haphazard doings of
the pursuers on the earlier occasion. Armadale had evidently issued
stringent orders, for not a tuft of undergrowth was left unexamined as
the line slowly closed in upon the hunted man. Every possible piece of
cover was scrutinized and beaten before the cordon passed beyond it.

“Very pretty,” Sir Clinton commented, as they moved up in the rear of
the line. “The Inspector must surely have been training these fellows.
They really do the business excellently.”

Michael suddenly left the path they were following and stepped across
under the trees.

“I’m going to have a look at that Fairy House myself,” he declared.
“That’s where I found Maurice after the last show. I want to be
perfectly certain that it’s empty.”

He opened the door, leaned inside the building, and then came back to
his companions. Something like disappointment was visible in his
expression. He was taken aback to see glances of sardonic amusement
exchanged between Cecil and the Chief Constable.

“Drawn blank, have you?” Cecil inquired.

“There’s no one there at present,” Michael admitted.

“I don’t think the constables would have missed a plain thing like
that,” Sir Clinton remarked mildly, though with a faint undertone of
correction in his voice.

Before Michael had time to reply they heard Armadale’s voice. The
cordon had passed completely through the spinney and was now on the
edge of the marble terrace.

“Come along,” Sir Clinton urged. “We mustn’t miss the final scene.”

They hurriedly joined the line just as Armadale ordered a last
advance.

“He’s somewhere on this terrace,” he told his men. “See that he
doesn’t break away from you at the last moment.”

Sir Clinton turned to Michael.

“Just the same as before?”

Michael made a gesture of assent.

“I’ll admit that this is more businesslike.”

The Constabulary line crept forward almost foot by foot, subjecting
every one of the marble seats to the most rigid scrutiny. Inspector
Armadale’s anxiety was more and more apparent as the cordon advanced
without securing the man for whom they were searching. At last the
whole of the possible cover had been beaten, and the constables
emerged on the open terrace. The fugitive had vanished, apparently,
into thin air.

Michael Clifton turned to the Chief Constable with an ironical smile.

“_Just_ the same as last time, it seems. How history repeats itself!”

The Inspector hurried across the terrace to where they were standing.
It was obvious that he was completely staggered by the turn of events.

“He’s got away, sir,” he reported in a mortified voice. “I can’t think
how he’s managed it.”

“I think we’ll repeat that last stage again, Inspector, if you don’t
mind. Withdraw your men till they’re just in front of that last line
of seats.”

While the Inspector was giving his orders Sir Clinton pulled his case
from his pocket, opened it, and thoughtfully tapped a cigarette on the
lid. Before lighting it he threw a glance up and down the empty spaces
of the terrace from which the fugitive had so mysteriously vanished.

“All plain and above board, isn’t it?” he said, turning to his two
companions. “I’ve got nothing in my hands except a cigarette, and you
can search my sleeves if you like. It is required, as Euclid would
say, to produce a full-sized burglar for the satisfaction of the
audience. It’s a stiff job.”

He glanced again over the wide white pavement of the terrace.

“A conjurer’s usually allowed a little patter, isn’t he? The quickness
of the tongue distracts the eye, and all that. Just a question, then.
Do you happen to remember what Medusa was able to do? Turned things
into stone when she looked at them, didn’t she? That somehow brings
the late Pygmalion to my mind—a kind of association of opposites, in a
way, I suppose. But I’ve often wondered what Pygmalion felt like when
the statue came to life.”

He turned sharply on his heel.

“You can come down off that pedestal, my friend. The game’s up!”

To the amazement of the group around him, the white marble statue
above him started suddenly into life. It leapt down from its base on
to the pavement of the terrace, staggered as it alighted, and then, as
Cecil and Michael grasped at its smooth sides, it shook itself clear
and sprang upon the broad marble balustrade.

“Come back, you fool!” Sir Clinton snapped, as the figure faced
outward to the gulf below.

But instead of halting, the white form gathered itself together for an
instant and then dived headlong into the abyss. There was the sound of
a splash; and an appalling cry came up through the night.

Sir Clinton dashed to the rail.

“Below, there! Get out on that raft at once and pick him up. He’s
badly hurt. He’ll drown if you don’t hurry.”

The Inspector hurried forward.

“Why didn’t you warn us, sir? We’d have had Marden as easy as
anything. If you’d only told us what to expect.”

Sir Clinton looked round.

“Marden? That’s not Marden. I tell you, Inspector, if that jump of his
meant anything, it suggests that there’s no Marden at all.”

The Inspector’s amazement overbore his chagrin.

“I don’t understand . . .” he began.

“Never mind. I’ll explain later. Get away down to the water-side at
once. See if he’s badly damaged. Quick, now.”

As the Inspector hurried off, the Chief Constable turned to Michael
Clifton.

“History doesn’t always repeat itself exactly, you see.”

He pulled out a match-box and lit his cigarette in a leisurely
fashion. Then, throwing away the vesta, he inquired:

“You see now how he got away from you last time?”

Michael made no reply. He was examining the pedestal from which the
living statue had taken its flight; and he could see the scores and
cuts left by the chisel which had smoothed the standing-place of the
original marble figure. Quite obviously, on the night of the masked
ball, the same trick had been played; and while the pursuers were
searching all around, the fugitive had stood rigid above them,
unsuspected by any one.

Cecil turned to the Chief Constable.

“Aren’t you going down to see if something can’t be done for the poor
devil? He must have come a fearful smash on the rocks.”

“Poor devil?” Sir Clinton retorted. “That’s not a poor devil. That’s a
wild beast, if you’re anxious for information. But if you’re a member
of the Society for the Prevention of Cruelty to Animals, I suppose
we’d better see that things are done decently and in order. We’ll go
down, if you’re perturbed about him.”

It took them some little time to descend to the level of the lakelet.
They could see, as they went down, the process of rescue; and when
they reached the water-side, they found two constables stooping over a
limp white figure, beside which the Inspector knelt solicitously. As
the newcomers approached, Armadale rose and stepped over to them.

“He’s done for, sir,” he reported in a low voice to Sir Clinton. “His
pelvis is smashed and I think his spine must have gone as well. He’s
paralysed below the waist. I doubt if he’ll last long. It was a
fearful smash.”

Cecil crossed over and peered down at the face of the dying man. For a
moment he failed to recognize him; for the white grease-paint
disguised the natural appearance of the features: but a closer
scrutiny revealed the identity of the living statue.

“Why, it’s the chauffeur!”

“Of course,” was all that Sir Clinton thought it worth while to say.

Armadale brought something up from the water-side.

“Here’s the waterproof he was wearing, sir. It’s Marden’s, just as I
told you when I saw him in the museum to-night. When he flung it over
the edge of the cliff as we were coming up, it landed on a broad bit
of rock instead of sinking like the Pierrot costume, the other night.”

Sir Clinton was silent for a moment. His glance wandered to the
broken, white-clad figure on the ground, but no pity showed on his
face. Then he turned back to Armadale.

“See if you can get a confession out of him, Inspector. He won’t live
long at the best; and he might as well tell what he can. We can’t hang
him now, unfortunately; and he may as well save us some trouble in
piecing things together. For one thing, he’s got a bag or a suit-case
lying around somewhere in the neighbourhood with a suit of clothes in
it. You’d better find out where that is, and save us the bother of
hunting for it. If you manage to get anything out of him, take it down
and get it witnessed. Bring it down to Ravensthorpe at once.”

He paused, then added as if by an after-thought:

“You’d better search these tights that he’s wearing. There ought to be
five of the medallions concealed about him somewhere. Get them for
me.”

He turned to Cecil and Michael.

“We’ll go back now to Ravensthorpe. Unless I’m far astray in my
deductions, there’s been another murder there; and we must keep the
girls from hearing about it, if we can.”

As they walked through the pine-wood, Sir Clinton maintained a
complete taciturnity, and neither of the others cared to break in on
his silence. His last words had shown that ahead of them might lie yet
another of the Ravensthorpe tragedies, and the shadow of it lay across
their minds. It was not until they were approaching the house that the
Chief Constable spoke again.

“You’ve spun that yarn I gave you to the girls?”

“They know there was some stunt afoot,” said Cecil, “but they were to
keep out of the way, in their rooms, until we were clear of the
house.”

“One had to tell them something,” Sir Clinton answered. “If one
hadn’t, they’d have been pretty uncomfortable when all that racket
started. You managed to scare him out very neatly with the row you
raised when I blew my whistle.”

“The girls are sitting up, waiting for us,” Cecil explained. “They
said they’d have coffee ready when we came back.”

“The deuce they did!”

Sir Clinton was obviously put out.

“I’d been counting on their going back to bed again. Then we could
have got Marden’s body away quietly—if he’s been murdered, as I think
he has. There’s no use upsetting people if you can avoid it.
Ravensthorpe’s had its fill of sensations lately and there’s no need
to add another to-night.”

He reflected as he walked on, and at last he seemed to hit on an
expedient to suit the circumstances.

“The bottom’s out of this case now,” he said, at last. “There’ll be no
trial; so there’s no need for any more secrecy, so far as I can see.
I’ll be giving nothing away that I shouldn’t, at this stage of the
game.”

He threw away the end of his cigarette and looked up at the bulk of
Ravensthorpe before them. Here and there on the dark front the yellow
oblong of a window shone out in the night.

“Suppose I spin them a yarn,” Sir Clinton went on. “I can keep them up
until dawn with it. After that, they’ll sleep sound enough; and while
they’re asleep, we’ll get Marden’s body away in peace and comfort.
It’ll spare them the shock of finding another corpse on the premises;
and that’s always something gained.”

When they reached Ravensthorpe, Sir Clinton turned to Cecil.

“You’d better go and close the safe in the museum. No use leaving
things like that open any longer than’s necessary. I must go up to
Marden’s room now. I’ll be back again in a minute or two.”

Ascending the servants’ staircase, Sir Clinton made his way to the
valet’s room. The door was locked; but when Sir Clinton tapped gently,
a constable opened it and looked out. At the sight of the Chief
Constable, he stood aside.

“He’s been murdered, sir,” the man explained in a whisper.

“I guessed it might be that,” Sir Clinton returned.

“Whoever did it must have chloroformed him first,” the constable went
on. “There was a pad of cotton-wool over his face; and his throat’s
cut.”

The Chief Constable nodded in comprehension.

“That would prevent any sounds,” he said. “Brackley was a first-class
planner, there’s no doubt.”

The constable continued his explanation.

“We came up here as you told us, sir; and when we heard your whistle
we slipped into the room, expecting to arrest him according to your
orders. But he was dead by that time. It was quite clear that he’d
been murdered only a short time before. Your orders didn’t cover the
case, so we thought the best thing to do was to lock the door and wait
till you came back. You’d said we were to keep him here till your
return, anyhow; so that seemed to be the best course.”

“Quite correct,” Sir Clinton commended them. “You couldn’t have done
better. Now you’ll need to wait here till morning. Keep the door
locked, and don’t let any word of this affair get abroad. I’ll see
about removing the body in due course. Until then, I don’t want any
alarm on the subject.”

He stepped across the room, examined the body on the bed, and then,
with a nod to the constables, he went downstairs once more.



CHAPTER XV

Sir Clinton’s Solution

“It’s a pleasure to meet Sir Clinton again,” Joan observed when they
had finished their coffee. “For the last ten days or so, I’ve been
dealing with a man they call the Chief Constable. I don’t much care
for him. These beetle-browed officials are not my sort. Too stiff and
overbearing for me, altogether.”

Sir Clinton laughed at the hit.

“Sorry,” he said. “I’ve invited one of your aversions to join us. In
fact, I think I hear him at the door now.”

“Inspector Armadale?” Joan demanded. “Well, I’ve nothing against him.
You never let him get a word in edgeways at our interviews. Grasping,
I call it.”

The door opened and the Inspector was ushered in. As he entered, a
glance passed between him and Sir Clinton. In reply, Armadale made a
furtive gesture which escaped the rest of the company.

“Passed in his checks,” Sir Clinton interpreted it to himself. “That
clears the road.”

Joan poured out coffee for the Inspector and then turned to the Chief
Constable.

“Cecil promised that you’d tell us all about everything. Don’t linger
over it. We’re all in quite good listening form and we look to you not
to be boring. Proceed.”

Sir Clinton refused to be disconcerted.

“Inspector Armadale’s the last authority on the subject,” he remarked.
“He’s got the confession of the master mind in his pocket. I haven’t
seen it yet. Suppose I give you my account of things, and the
Inspector will check it for us where necessary? That seems a fair
division of labour.”

“Very fair,” Una Rainhill put in. “Now, Joan, be quiet and let’s get
on with the tale.”

“Before the curtain goes up,” Sir Clinton suggested, “you’d better
read your programmes. First of all you find the name of Thomas
Pailton, _alias_ Cocoa Tom, _alias_, J. B. Foss, _alias_ The Wizard of
Woz: a retired conjurer, gaolbird, confidence-trick sharp, etc. As I
read his psychology, he was rather a weak character and not over
straight even in dealing with his equals. In the present play, he was
acting under the orders of a gentleman of much tougher fibre.

“The next name on the programme is Thomas Marden. The police have no
records of his early doings, but I suspect that Mr. Marden had cause
to bless his luck in this respect, rather than his honesty. I’m sure
he wasn’t a prentice hand. As to his character, I believe he was
rather a violent person when roused, and he had a deplorable lack of
control over a rather bad temper.

“The third name is . . . ?”

“Stephen Racks,” the Inspector supplied in answer to Sir Clinton’s
glance of inquiry.

“_Alias_ Joe Brackley,” Sir Clinton continued. “I think we’ll call him
Brackley, since that was the name you knew him by, if you knew him at
all. He was nominally Foss’s chauffeur. Actually, I think, he was the
brain of the gang and did the planning for them.”

“That’s correct,” the Inspector interpolated.

“Mr. Brackley, I think, was the most deliberately unscrupulous of them
all,” Sir Clinton continued. “A really dangerous person who would
stick at nothing to get what he wanted or to cover his tracks.

“Then, last of all, there’s a Mr. Blank, whose name I do not know, but
who at present is under arrest in America for forging the name of Mr.
Kessock the millionaire. He was employed by Mr. Kessock in some
capacity or other which gave him access to Mr. Kessock’s
correspondence. I’ve no details on that point as yet.”

“This is the kind of stuff I always skip when I’m reading a detective
story,” complained Joan. “Can’t you get along to something interesting
soon?”

“You’re like the Bellman in the ‘Hunting of the Snark,’ Joan. ‘Oh,
skip your dear uncle!’ Well, I skip, as you desire it. I’ll merely
mention in passing that an American tourist came here a while ago and
asked to see the Leonardo medallions, because he was writing a book on
Leonardo. He, I believe, was Mr. Blank from America; and his job was
to see the safe in the museum and note its pattern.

“I must skip again; and now we reach the night of the robbery in the
museum. You know what happened then. Mr. Foss came to me with his tale
about overhearing some of you planning a practical joke. His story was
true enough, I’ve no doubt; but it set me thinking at once. I may not
have shown it, Joan, but I quite agreed with you about his methods. It
seemed a funny business to come straight to the police over a thing of
that sort. Of course he had his reason ready; but it didn’t ring quite
true, somehow. I might have put it down to tactlessness, if it hadn’t
suggested something else to my mind.

“That pistol-shot which smashed the lamp was too neatly timed for my
taste. It was fired by some one who knew precisely when the keeper was
going to be gripped, and it was fired just in time to get ahead of
Foxton Polegate in the raid on the show-case. That meant, if it meant
anything, that the man who fired the shot was a person who knew of the
practical joke. But on the face of it, Foss was the only person who
knew about the joke, bar the jokers themselves. So naturally I began
to suspect Foss of having a hand in the business. It was the usual
mistake of the criminal—trying to be too clever and throw suspicion on
to some one else.

“Now Foss wasn’t the man in white, obviously; for he came to see me
while the man-hunt was still in full cry. So at that stage in the
business I was fairly certain that at least two people were in the
game: Foss and some one else, who was the man in white. That looked
like either the valet or the chauffeur, since they were the only
people I knew about who were directly associated with Foss while he
was here. But this incognito business at the masked ball had made it
possible for outsiders to come in unrecognized; so the man in white
might be a confederate quite outside our range of knowledge. One
couldn’t assume that either Marden or Brackley was in the show at all.

“I learned, later on, that Foss had synchronized his watch with yours,
Cecil; and that, of course, made it pretty plain that he was in the
game. There was also another bit of evidence which suggested
something. If either the valet or the chauffeur was the confederate,
then they could easily enough have found out from the servants what
costume Maurice meant to wear that night—a few questions to his valet
would have got the information—and they could have chosen the Pierrot
costume for their own runner in order to confuse things. That
suggested that Foss’s servants might be in the business; but it proved
nothing really. The white Pierrot costume was chosen mainly for its
conspicuousness, I’m sure.

“Now I come to the disappearance of the man in white.”

“Thank goodness!” Joan commented. “It gets more interesting as it goes
on, doesn’t it? That’s something to be thankful for.”

“One does one’s best,” Sir Clinton retorted, unperturbed. “Now the
vanishing of that fellow could be accounted for in various ways, so
far as I could see. First of all, he might have slipped down the rope
into the little lake. That was what the rope was meant to suggest,
obviously. But unfortunately one of the hunters had the wit to keep an
eye on the lake; and it was pretty clear the man in white didn’t go
that way. Then there was the possibility of his being concealed in the
cave; but that was ruled out by the search of the cave. Thirdly, the
gang might have hit on the opening of one of the secret passages of
Ravensthorpe. Candidly, I ruled that out also. It seemed next door to
impossible. But if you exclude all these ways, then there seem to be
only two possibilities left. The first of these depends on the man in
white having a confederate in the cordon who let him slip through. But
the chance of a slip-through of that sort escaping the notice of the
rest of the hunters seemed very small. It seemed to me too risky a
business for them to have tried.

“The final possibility was that the fugitive disguised himself as
something else. Well, what disguise would be the best? It’s a question
of camouflage, and they had only a few seconds to do the camouflaging.
You can’t dress up as a drain-pipe or a garden-seat in a couple of
seconds. So we come down to something that’s human in shape but isn’t
really human. In a garden, you might pretend to be a scarecrow; but up
on that terrace a scarecrow was out of the question. And then I
remembered the statues.

“Suppose somebody had gone up there in the evening and had chiselled
one of the statues off its base. The broken marble could be heaved
over into the little lake and the bare pedestal would be left for the
fugitive.”

“I ought to have thought of that,” Michael interjected. “It’s so
obvious when you think of it. But I didn’t think of anything like that
at the time.”

“My impression then,” Sir Clinton continued, “was that the man in
white had white tights on under his Pierrot dress. His face and hands
were whitened, also; so that as soon as he stripped off his jacket and
trousers, he was sufficiently statuelike to pass muster in that light.
His eyes would have given him away in daylight; but under the moon
he’d only got to shut them and you’d hardly notice his whitened
eyelashes. In the few moments that you left him, while the cordon was
being formed, he took off his Pierrot things, wrapped them round the
weight he’d used in breaking the case’s glass, and pitched the lot
over the balustrade. That would account for the splash that was
heard.”

Sir Clinton paused to light a cigarette.

“That theory seemed to fit most of the evidence, as you see. It
explained why they’d chosen that particular place for the disappearing
trick; and it accounted for the splash as well. Further, it suggested
that there was a third man in the gang: the man who smashed down the
real statue. They’d leave that bit of work to the last moment for fear
of the damage being seen accidentally beforehand. Now Foss was at the
masked ball, so it wasn’t he. The man in white might need all his
powers in that race, so it was unlikely that he’d been up there on a
heavy bit of manual labour just then, for the shifting of that statue,
even in pieces, can have been no light affair. That suggested the use
of a third confederate. But I’m no wild enthusiast for theories. I
simply noted the coincidence that this theory demanded three men and
that Foss’s party contained three men: himself, the valet, and the
chauffeur.

“Now, for reasons which I’ll give you immediately, it seemed likely
that this affair was only a first step in a more complicated plan. On
the spur of the moment, I decided it was worth while taking a hand. So
I got a patrol set round the spinney and issued orders that no one was
to go up to the terrace until I’d been over the ground. I took good
care that every one knew about this; and I took equally good care not
to go there myself. I rather advertised the thing, in fact. That was
to assure the fellows that no one had seen the empty pedestal. They
were pretty certain to rout about for information; and they’d hear on
all sides that no one had been up to the terrace. That left the thing
open for them to try again if they wanted to.

“Another thing confirmed my notions. When the Inspector was dragging
the lake, he got a largish piece of marble out of it. That fitted in
with the view that the broken statue was down in the water in
fragments, hidden by the weeds. It all fitted fairly well, you see.

“Then came another bit of evidence—two bits, in fact. The village
drunkard put abroad some yarn about seeing a White Man in the woods;
and a little girl saw a Black Man. That might have been mere fancy. Or
it might have been true enough. When the hunters had gone, the
pseudo-statue would come down off his pedestal. Suppose he wandered
off into the wood and was seen by old Groby. There’s your White Man.
But he couldn’t possibly get back to the house in white tights. He’d
want to get in as quietly as possible. What about a set of black
tights under the white ones? When he took off the white ones, he’d be
next door to invisible among shadows; and he’d be able to sneak in
through a window in the servants’ wing—in the shadow of the
house—fairly inconspicuously. Perhaps that’s how it happened.”

“That was it,” the Inspector confirmed, looking up from a sheet of
paper which he was consulting from time to time.

Sir Clinton acknowledged the confirmation but refused to lay much
stress on the point.

“I thought it possible,” he said, “but it was merely a guess. In
itself the evidence wasn’t worth anything; but it fitted well enough
into the hypothesis I’d made.”

He turned to the Inspector.

“Did you get the five medallions as I expected?”

Armadale put his hand into his pocket and withdrew the five discs of
gold, which he handed over to the Chief Constable. Sir Clinton took
the sixth medallion from his own pocket and laid the whole set on the
table beside him.

“They say,” he went on, “that the more _outré_ a crime is, the easier
it is to find a solution for it. I shouldn’t like to assert that in
every case. But there’s no harm in paying especial attention to the
bizarre points in an affair. If you cast your minds back to the case
as it presented itself to us on the night of the masked ball, you’ll
recall one point which undoubtedly seemed out of the common.”

He glanced round the circle of listeners, but no one ventured to
interrupt.

“Here was a gang of thieves bent on stealing something. One of
them—Foss—knew that in the show-case there were three medallions and
three replicas. The medallions were of enormous value; the replicas
were worth next to nothing. Foss, I was sure—and it turned out
afterwards that I was right—Foss knew that the real medallions were in
the top row and that the replicas were in the lower row.”

He arranged the six discs on the table as he spoke.

“And yet, with that knowledge, it was the replicas which they stole
and not the real medallions. Amazing, at first sight, isn’t it? To my
mind it was much more bizarre than the vanishing trick. And,
naturally, it was on that point in the case that I fixed my attention.
These weren’t blunderers, remember. The rest of the business showed
that they were anything but that. The way they had seized upon that
practical joke to serve their ends was quite enough to prove that
there was a good brain at the back of the thing. That joke wasn’t in
their original programme, and yet they’d taken it in their stride and
turned it to account in a most ingenious way. They weren’t the sort of
people who would make a mistake about the positions of the replicas.
If they took the electrotypes instead of the real things, it was
because the electrotypes were what they wanted.

“Why did they want them? That question seemed to thrust itself forward
in front of all the others which suggested themselves in the case; and
it was that question that had to be answered before one could see
light anywhere.”

He leaned forward in his chair and glanced at the two rows of
medallions on the table before him for a moment.

“If one thinks about a point long enough, it often happens that all of
a sudden a fresh idea turns up and fits into its place. I think it was
probably the notion of the pseudo-statue that put me on to this
affair. There you had a fraud imposing itself on some people simply
because they had no reason to suppose that any fraud was intended. I
doubt if any of you people, Mr. Clifton, gave a second glance at these
statues that night. You simply regarded them as statues, because you
knew that statues were on all the pedestals in normal circumstances.
You were off your guard on that particular point.

“That idea seemed to give me the key to this mysterious preference for
replicas. If they’d taken the real medallions that night, with all the
fuss that was made, then you Ravensthorpe people would have known at
once that the true Leonardos had gone; and, naturally, with the theft
of them dated to a minute, the risk was considerable. But suppose that
the theft of the replicas was only the first stage in the game, what
then? They had the replicas; you had the real medallions. Foss, as the
agent for Kessock, had every excuse for asking to see the medallions
again.

“Now at that point there would come in the very same subconscious
assurance that played into their hands in the case of the statue.
Maurice would know for certain that the three things in his safe were
the real Leonardos. He’d fish them out for Foss to examine; and he’d
put them back in the safe without any minute inspection when Foss
handed them over. The replicas would be off the board—lost, gone for
good. He’d never think of them.”

Sir Clinton glanced mischievously at Joan before continuing.

“As it happens, I can do a little parlour conjuring myself. It comes
in handy when one has to live up to the part of Prospero or anything
like that. I know what one can do in the way of palming things, and so
forth. And as soon as I hit on this idea of the case, I saw how things
might be managed. Foss would fake up some excuse for handling the real
medallions; and during that handling, he’d substitute the replicas for
the Leonardos. Maurice, having apparently had the things under his
eyes all the time, would never think of examining the medals which he
got back from Foss’s hands. He’d simply put them back into the safe.
Foss would have the real things in his pocket; the deal would fall
through; Foss & Co. would retire gracefully . . . and it was a hundred
to one that no minute examination of the medallions in the safe would
be made for long enough. By that time it would be impossible either to
find Foss or to bring the thing home to him even if you did find him.

“You see the advantages? First of all, the only theft would be one of
the replicas, which no one cared much about. Second, the date of the
real theft would be left doubtful. And third, this plan gave them any
amount of time to dispose of the real things before any suspicions
were aroused at all, as regards the genuine Leonardos. My impression
is that they had a market for them: some scoundrelly collector who’d
pay high to have the Leonardos even if he couldn’t boast publicly that
he had them.”

“That’s correct, sir,” the Inspector interposed. “Brackley had a
market, but he wouldn’t tell me who the collector was.”

Joan rose from her chair, crossed the room to a small table, and
solemnly came back with a tray.

“Have some whisky and soda,” she suggested to Sir Clinton.

“You find the tale rather dry?” he inquired solicitously. “Life’s like
that, you know. Inspector Armadale really needs this more than I do.
He’s been a long time out in the cold up yonder. I’ll take some later
on, if you don’t mind.”

Joan presented the tray to the Inspector, who helped himself.

Sir Clinton waited till he was finished with the siphon and then
continued, addressing himself to Joan:

“Perhaps the story has lacked feminine interest up to this point.
We’ll hurry on to the day when you, Maurice, and Foss had your talk on
the terrace. Down below was Foss’s motor, serving two purposes. It was
there if they had to make a bolt, should things go wrong. It also
allowed the chauffeur, making a fake repair, to watch what went on in
the museum. I gather that he meant to keep an eye on his confederates.

“At that moment, Foss had the three replicas in his pocket; and he was
looking for some excuse to carry out the exchange. He led the
conversation on to Japanese swords and so forth. I suspect Brackley
supplied the basis for that matter, enough to allow Foss to make a
show of information. Then Foss brought up the subject of his ‘poor
man’s collection’ of rubbings. I’ve no doubt he forced a card
there—induced Maurice to offer to let him take rubbings of the
medallions. That would be child’s play to an ex-conjurer with a smart
tongue. He got his way, anyhow.

“But then came a complication he hadn’t expected. You, Joan, got
interested in this taking of rubbings. I admit it was hard lines on
the poor fellow. It was the last thing he could have anticipated.”

“Thanks for the compliment!” Joan interjected, ironically.

“Well, it wasn’t in the plan, anyhow,” Sir Clinton went on. “It meant
an extra pair of eyes to deceive when the exchange was made; and as
the exchange was the crucial move in the whole scheme, your
company—strange to say—was not appreciated. In fact, you made Mr. Foss
nervous. He wasn’t quite as cool as he could have wished; and my
reading of the situation is that he bungled his first attempt at the
substitution and had to prolong the agony by pretending to take a
second rubbing of the first medallion he got into his hands.

“He had more luck with his second attempt, even with your eagle eyes
on him; and he stowed away Medallion Number One in one of the special
concealed pockets which he had in his clothes. But he desired
intensely to be relieved of your company; and he proceeded to draw
your attention to some one calling you. Of course that voice existed
solely in his own imagination. But it was quite as effective as a real
voice in getting you to leave the museum; and then there was one
onlooker the less to bother him in his sleight-of-hand.”

Sir Clinton paused to light a cigarette before continuing. Inspector
Armadale, laying down his paper, turned to the Chief Constable as
though expecting at this point to hear something which he did not
already know.

“The next stage is one of pure conjecture,” Sir Clinton went on. “Foss
is dead, and I haven’t had any opportunity of interrogating the other
actor: Marden.”

Inspector Armadale smiled grimly at the way in which the Chief
Constable evaded any reference to the valet’s murder.

“Possibly Inspector Armadale has a note or two on the matter,” Sir
Clinton pursued, “but even if he has, it can only be something like
‘what the soldier said,’ for Brackley could have merely second-hand
evidence at the best. Take the case as the Inspector and I found it.
Foss was dead, stabbed with the Muramasa sword. On its handle we found
the finger-prints of Maurice, and no others. Under Foss’s body we
found an undischarged automatic pistol with his finger-prints on the
butt. We noticed curious pockets in Foss’s clothes; but they were
empty. And we found no trace of any of the medallions about the place.
Maurice was _non est inventus_—we could see no sign of him. Marden had
cut his hand in a fall against one of the cases. He’d wrapped it up
with his handkerchief in a rough sort of way. The case containing the
Muramasa sword was open, and the sheath was lying in it, empty, of
course.

“It’s only fair to Inspector Armadale to tell you that he suspected
Marden immediately. What I’m going to give you is merely the case as
it presented itself to me.”

Armadale looked slightly flustered by this tribute to his
perspicacity. He glanced suspiciously at the Chief Constable, but Sir
Clinton’s face betrayed no ironical intention.

“He may be pulling my leg again,” the Inspector reflected, “but at
least it’s decent of him to go out of his way to say that. It’s true
enough, but not exactly in the way that they’ll understand it.”

“Marden had a very complete story to tell us. He’d come to the door of
the museum with a parcel which Foss had sent him to post. He’d found
the address was incomplete and came back to get Foss to finish it. He
stayed outside the door and he heard a quarrel between Maurice and
Foss, ending in a struggle. When he burst into the room, Maurice was
disappearing at the other end and Foss was dead on the floor. Then
Marden slipped on the parquet, fell against a show-case, cut his hand,
and tied it up in his handkerchief. Then he gave the alarm.

“The parcel with the incomplete address was the first thing that
interested me. We opened it and we found in it a cheap wrist-watch in
perfect condition, apparently. The Inspector tried it for
finger-prints. There weren’t any of any sort, either on the watch or
the box in which it was enclosed. That seemed a bit rum to us both.

“The only thing that seemed to fit the case was this. Suppose Marden
wanted to keep an eye on Foss. This parcel would give him an excuse of
bursting in on his employer at any moment. Assume that Marden himself
had made up the parcel and that Foss had nothing to do with it. It was
wrapped up in paper on which the address was written. You know how one
writes on a parcel—not the least like one’s normal handwriting if the
paper is crumpled a bit in the wrapping-up. That would make a bit of
rough forgery of Foss’s writing fairly easy. Further, if by any chance
the parcel fell into the hands of the police—as actually
happened—there was nothing inside to show that Foss hadn’t wrapped it
up himself. Nobody else’s finger-marks were on it at all. It had been
wrapped up with gloved hands. And the contents were innocent enough:
only a watch being sent to a watch-maker to be regulated, perhaps. If
it had been a letter, then to carry the thing through properly they’d
have had to forge Foss’s writing all the way through, in order to make
it look genuine if it happened to be opened.

“But if that theory were adopted, a lot followed from it. First and
foremost, it meant that Marden was the boss and his nominal employer
was an underling in the gang, who would have to back up any story that
Marden liked to tell. Secondly, it pointed to the fact that Marden
didn’t trust Foss much. He wanted an excuse to get at Foss at any
moment—which is hardly in the power of a simple valet. When he thought
Foss needed watching, all he had to do was to trot up with his little
parcel, just to let Foss see that he was under observation. Thirdly,
this dodge was worked at a crucial stage in the game—when the replicas
were being exchanged for the Leonardo medallions. Doesn’t that suggest
that Marden didn’t trust Foss very much? It looks as if Marden was
none too sure that he’d get a square deal from Foss once the real
medallions had changed hands. Am I right in my guesses, Inspector?”

“They didn’t trust Foss to play straight, sir. Brackley was quite open
about that.”

“And it was Brackley’s idea? The parcel, I mean. It looks as if it
came from his mint.”

“He said so, sir. Foss knew nothing about it, of course. It was a
surprise for him. They knew he’d have to pretend he knew all about it
when Marden brought it to him.”

“That finishes the parcel,” Sir Clinton continued. “But it had
suggested one or two things, as you see. The most important thing,
from my point of view, was that this gang was not exactly a band of
brothers. Two of them suspected the third. Possibly the split was even
more extensive.

“The next thing was the valet’s story. According to him, Maurice
stabbed Foss, after a quarrel which Marden couldn’t overhear clearly.
Unfortunately for that tale, the blow that killed Foss was a powerful
one. What Marden didn’t know was that Maurice had sprained his wrist
that morning. I doubt if a sprained wrist could have achieved that
stab. There was no proof, of course; but it seemed just a little
doubtful. Then Marden said that from the door he couldn’t catch the
words of the quarrel, although the voices were angry in tone. I tried
the experiment myself later; and it’s perfectly easy to overhear
what’s said in the museum from the position Marden said he was in. So
that was a deliberate lie. On that basis, one could eliminate most of
Marden’s tale as being under suspicion.

“What really happened in the museum? Maurice is gone, Foss is dead,
Marden won’t tell. One has just to reconstruct the thing as plausibly
as one can. My impression—it’s only conjecture—is this. Marden was
listening at the door and he could see some parts of the room, since
the door was ajar. Foss had succeeded in substituting one replica for
a real medallion. To get Maurice’s eye off him, he asked to see the
Muramasa sword. Maurice went to get it, leaving Foss at his
rubbing—visible to Maurice all the time. Foss made the exchange of the
second replica at that moment. Maurice came back with the Muramasa
sword—and of course in doing that, he put his finger-prints on the
handle in drawing the blade from the sheath. Marden, at the door, saw
him do this and made a note of it. Just as Maurice came back to Foss,
he was suddenly taken ill. He had the third real medallion in one
hand; and as he passed Foss he picked up the two replicas—which he
believed to be the other two real medallions. He went to the safe and
hurriedly put on a shelf the two replicas; but the other medallion, in
his other hand, he forgot all about. He shut the safe and staggered
into the secret passage.”

Inspector Armadale looked frankly incredulous.

“Do people take ill all of a sudden like that?” he demanded. “Why
should he want to rush off all at once?”

Sir Clinton swung round on him.

“Ever suffered from rheumatism, Inspector? Or neuralgia? Or
toothache?”

“No,” the Inspector replied with all the pride of perfect health.
“I’ve never had rheumatism and I’ve never had a tooth go wrong in my
life.”

“No wonder you can’t understand, then,” Sir Clinton retorted. “Wait
till you have neuralgia in the fifth nerve, Inspector. Then, if you
don’t know yourself that you’re unfit for human society, your friends
will tell you, soon enough. If you get a bad attack, it’s
maddening—nothing less. Men have suicided on account of it often
enough,” he added, with a meaning glance at Armadale.

A light broke in on the Inspector’s mind.

“So that was it? No wonder I couldn’t put two and two together!” he
reflected to himself; but he made no audible comment.

“Now we come to a mere leap in the dark,” Sir Clinton continued. “I
believe that as soon as Maurice was out of the way, Marden went into
the museum and demanded the medallions from Foss.”

He put down his cigarette and leaned back in his chair. When he spoke
again, a faint tinge of pity seemed to come into his voice.

“Foss was a poor little creature, hardly better than a rabbit in the
big jungle of crime. And the other two were something quite different:
carnivores, beasts of prey. They’d picked him out simply on account of
his one miserable talent: his little trick of legerdemain. He was only
a tool, poor beggar, and he knew it. I expect that when he saw what
sort of company he’d fallen into, he was terrified. That would account
for the pistol he carried.

“His only chance of a fair deal from them lay in the fact that he had
the real medallions in his possession; and he meant to hold on to
them. And when Marden demanded them, Foss revolted. It must have been
like the revolt of a rabbit against a stoat. He hadn’t a chance. He
pulled out his pistol, I expect; and when that appeared, Marden saw
red.

“But Marden, even in a fury, was a person with a very keen mind.
Perhaps he’d thought the thing over beforehand. He was evidently one
of these sub-human creatures with no respect for human life—the things
they label Apaches in Paris. When the pistol came out he was ready for
it. Foss, I’m sure, brandished the thing in an amateurish fashion—he
wasn’t a gunman of any sort. Probably he imagined that the mere sight
of the thing would bring Marden to heel.

“Marden had his handkerchief out at once. Probably he had it ready in
his hand. He picked up the Muramasa sword, leaving no finger-marks of
his own on it through the handkerchief. And . . . that was the end of
Foss.”

Sir Clinton leaned over, selected a fresh cigarette with a certain
fastidiousness, and lighted it before going on with his tale.

“That was the end of his feeble little attempt to get the better of
his confederate. The money in his pocket-book didn’t give him the
escape he’d hoped for. All his precautions to leave no clues to his
real identity played straight into the hands of Marden and Brackley.

“Marden’s immediate problem, once he’d come out of his fury, was
difficult enough. I suspect that his first move was to search Foss and
get the medallions out of his pockets. Then he was faced with the
blood on his hands and on his handkerchief. He had his plan made
almost in a moment. He went across, deliberately slipped—he was an
artist in detail, evidently—smashed against the glass of one of the
cases, cut his hand, and then he felt fairly secure. He wrapped up the
wounds in his handkerchief—and there was the case complete to account
for any stray blood anywhere on his clothes. He tried the safe, for
fear Maurice was lurking inside; and then he gave the alarm.”

Sir Clinton glanced inquiringly at the Inspector, but Armadale shook
his head.

“Brackley had nothing to say about all that, sir. Marden gave him no
details.”

“It’s mostly guess-work,” Sir Clinton warned his audience. “All that
one can say for it is that it fits the facts fairly well.”

“And is that brute in the house now?” Una Rainhill demanded. “I shan’t
go to sleep if he is.”

“Two constables were detached to arrest him,” Sir Clinton assured her.
“He’s not on the premises, you may count on that.”

Inspector Armadale’s face took on a wooden expression, the result of
suppressing a sardonic smile.

“Well, he does manage to tell the truth and convey a wrong impression
with it,” he commented inwardly.

“Now consider the state of affairs after the Foss murder,” Sir Clinton
went on. “Marden and Brackley were in a pretty pickle, it seems to me.
They had three medallions which Marden had got when he rifled Foss’s
body. But _they didn’t know what they’d got_. They weren’t in the
secret of the dots on the replicas. For all they knew—knew for
certain, I mean—Foss might have bungled the affair and the things they
had might be merely replicas. If so, they were no good. I can’t tell
the difference between a medallion and an electrotype myself; but I
believe an expert can tell you whether a thing’s been struck with a
die or merely plated from a mould. These two scoundrels, I take it,
weren’t experts. They couldn’t tell which brand of article they had in
their hands.

“There was only one thing to be done. They’d have to get the whole six
things into their hands, and then they’d be sure of having the three
medallions. So they fell back on their original scheme of plain
burglary. That, I’m sure, had been their first plan. They’d sent their
American confederate to see the safe a long while ago; and no doubt
he’d reported that it was an old pattern. Hence the otophone, by means
of which they could pick the combination lock. The otophone was still
on the premises: I’d left it for them. But they were up against one
thing.

“I’d put a guard night and day on the museum. That blocked any attempt
at burglary unless they were prepared to take the tremendous risk of
manhandling the guard. If the door had merely been locked, I don’t
think it would have given them much trouble. I’m pretty sure there’s a
very good outfit of burglar’s tools mixed up with the tool-kit of the
car, where it would attract no attention. But the guard was a
difficulty in the way.”

Without making it obvious to the others, Sir Clinton made it clear to
Armadale that the next part of his story was meant specially for the
Inspector.

“I’d given you the view I held of the case at that point. I felt
fairly certain I was right. But if I’d been asked to put that case
before a jury, I certainly would have backed out. It was mostly
surmise: accurate enough, perhaps, but with far too little support. A
jury—quite rightly—wants facts and not theories. Could one even
convince them that the vanishing trick had been carried through as I
believed it had? It would have been a bit of a gamble. And I don’t
believe in that sort of gamble. I wanted the thing proved up to the
hilt. And the best way to do that was to catch them actually at work.

“There seemed to me just one weak point in the armour. I counted on a
split between the two remaining confederates, if I could only get a
wedge in somehow. I guessed, rightly or wrongly, that the Foss murder
would strike the chauffeur as a blunder, and that there might be the
makings of friction there. The chauffeur’s watching the museum under
cover of the fake repair to the hood suggested that he mistrusted the
others. I suspected that Marden might have stuck to the stuff he’d
taken off Foss’s body. If Brackley hadn’t got his share of that swag,
he’d be in a weak position. I gambled on that: everything to gain and
nothing much to lose. I had the chauffeur up for examination again;
and when I gave him an opening, he deliberately gave his friend away
by letting me know he’d seen Marden and Foss together just before the
murder. And when he did that, I blurted out to Inspector Armadale that
the guards on the terrace and the museum door were to be discontinued.
Brackley went off with those two bits of exclusive information. He
didn’t tell them to Marden. He saw his way to make the balance even
between himself and his confederate. If he kept his news to himself,
he could burgle the museum safe; get the remainder of the six
medallions; and then he’d be sure of getting his share of the profits.
Neither of them could do without the other in that case.

“In actual practice, Brackley went a stage farther than I’d
anticipated. He schemed to get Marden’s loot as well as the stuff from
the safe. I needn’t go into that side-issue.”

Again Inspector Armadale suppressed his amusement at the way in which
Sir Clinton chose to present the truth.

“The rest of the tale’s short enough,” Sir Clinton went on. “Brackley
determined to burgle the safe. If pursued, he decided, he’d repeat the
vanishing trick on the terrace; for I’d convinced him, apparently,
that the _modus operandi_ of it was still unknown to us. Probably he
went up there and satisfied himself that no one came near, after the
patrol was taken off. He got himself up for the part: whitened his
face; put on white tights; covered himself with Marden’s waterproof as
a disguise and to conceal his fancy dress; put on a big black mask to
hide the paint on his face, lest he should give the show away if an
interruption came. And so he walked straight into the trap I’d laid
for him.

“We saw the whole show from start to finish. I even let Cecil and Mr.
Clifton into the business, so that we’d have some evidence apart from
police witnesses. We saw the whole show from start to finish.”

Sir Clinton broke off his story and glanced at his watch.

“We’ve kept Inspector Armadale up to a most unconscionable hour,” he
said, apologetically. “We really mustn’t detain him till sunrise.
Before you go, Inspector, you might tell us if my solution fits the
confession you got out of Brackley—in the later stages, I mean.”

Inspector Armadale saw his dismissal and rose to his feet.

“There’s really nothing in the confession that doesn’t tally, sir.
Differences in detail, of course; but you were right in the main
outlines of the affair.”

Sir Clinton showed a faint satisfaction.

“Well, it’s satisfactory enough to hear that. By the way, Inspector,
you’d better take my car. It’s in the avenue still. Send a man up with
it, please, when you’ve done with it. There’s no need for you to walk
after a night like this.”

Armadale thanked him; declined Cecil’s offer of another whisky and
soda; and took his departure. When he had gone, Cecil threw a glance
of inquiry at the Chief Constable.

“Do you feel inclined to tell us what you made of my doings? I noticed
that you didn’t drag them out in front of the Inspector.”

Sir Clinton acquiesced in the suggestion.

“I think that’s fairly plain sailing; but correct me if I go wrong.
When you heard of Maurice’s disappearance, you saw that something was
very far amiss. You had a fair idea where he might be, but you didn’t
want to advertise the Ravensthorpe secrets. So you came back one night
and went down there. I don’t know whether you were surprised or not
when you found him; but in any case, you decided that there was no
good giving the newspapers a titbit about secret passages. So you took
him out into the glade by the other entrance to the tunnel; and then
you came up to Ravensthorpe as though you’d come by the first train.
The Inspector tripped you over that point, but it didn’t matter much.
He doesn’t love you, though, I suspect. I’d no desire to make matters
worse by interfering between you; for you seemed able to look after
yourself. Wasn’t that the state of affairs?”

“There or thereabouts,” Cecil admitted. “It seemed the best thing to
do, in the circumstances.”

Sir Clinton showed obvious distaste for discussing the matter further.
He turned to the girls.

“It’s high time you children were in bed. Dawn’s well up in the sky.
You’ve had all the excitement you need, for the present; and a good
sleep seems indicated.”

He gave a faint imitation of a stifled yawn.

“That sets me off,” said Una Rainhill, frankly. “I can hardly keep my
eyes open. Come along, Joan. It’s quite bright outside and I’m not
afraid to go to bed now.”

Joan rubbed her eyes.

“This sort of thing takes more out of one than twenty dances,” she
admitted. “The beginning of the night was a bit too exciting for
everyday use. How does one say ‘Good-night’ in proper form when the
sun’s over the horizon? I give it up.”

With a gesture of farewell, she made her way to the door, followed by
Una. When they had disappeared, Sir Clinton turned to Cecil
Chacewater.

“Care to walk down the avenue a little to meet my car? The fresh air
and all that. I rather like the dawn, myself, when it happens to come
my way without too much exertion.”

Cecil saw that the Chief Constable was giving him an opening if he
cared to take it.

“I’ll come along with you till you meet the car.”

Sir Clinton took leave of Michael Clifton, who obviously intended to
go to bed immediately. As soon as he was well clear of the house,
Cecil turned to the Chief Constable.

“You skated over thin ice several times in that yarn of yours.
Especially the bits about Maurice. Toothache! Neuralgia! That infernal
Inspector of yours swallowed it all down like cat-lap. From his face,
you’d have thought he picked up an absolute cert. that no one else
could see. I almost laughed, at that point.”

He changed suddenly to a serious tone.

“How did you spot what was really wrong with Maurice?”

“One thing led to another,” Sir Clinton confessed. “I didn’t hit on it
all at once. The Fairy Houses set me thinking at the start. One
doesn’t keep toys like that in good repair merely on account of some
old legend. They were quite evidently meant for use. And then, Cecil,
you seemed to have some private joke of your own—not a particularly
nice joke either—about them. That set me thinking. And after that, you
dropped some remark about Maurice having specialized in family
curses.”

“You seem to have a devil of a memory for trifles,” Cecil commented,
in some surprise.

“Trifles sometimes count for a good deal in my line,” Sir Clinton
pointed out. “One gets into the habit of docketing them, almost
without thinking about it. I must have pigeon-holed your talk about
the Fairy Houses quite mechanically. Then later on I remembered that
these things were dotted all over your estate and nowhere else. On
their own ground, the Chacewaters were always within easy distance of
one or other of these affairs. Ancient family curse; curious little
buildings very handy; one brother grinning—yes, you did grin, and
nastily too—at them, when you know he hates another brother like
poison. It was quite a pretty little problem. And so . . .”

“And so?” demanded Cecil, as Sir Clinton stopped short.

“And so I put it out of my mind. It wasn’t the sort of thing I cared
to think much about in connection with Ravensthorpe,” Sir Clinton
said, bluntly. “Besides, it was no affair of mine.”

“And then?”

“Then came Michael Clifton’s story of finding Maurice in one of these
Fairy Houses. And the details about the queer state Maurice was in
when he was found. That came up in connection with a crime; and crimes
are my business. Why does a fellow crawl away into a place like that?
Why does he resent being dragged out of it? Why won’t he even take the
trouble to get up? These were the kind of questions that absolutely
bristled over the whole affair. One couldn’t help getting an inkling.
But that inkling threw no light on the crime in hand, so it was no
affair of mine. I dropped it. But . . .”

“Yes?”

“Maurice wasn’t an attractive character, I’ll admit that. I loathed
the way he was going on. But I like to look on the best side of people
if I can. In my line, one sees plenty of the other side—more than
enough. And by and by I began to see that perhaps all Maurice’s doings
could be explained, if they couldn’t be excused. He was off his
balance.”

“He was, poor devil,” Cecil concurred, with some contrition in his
tone.

“Then came the time I forced you to open the secret passage. Your
methods were the very worst you could have chosen, Cecil. I knew
perfectly well that you hadn’t done anything to Maurice. You’re not
the fratricidal type. But you very evidently had something that you
wanted to conceal behind that door. You were afraid of my spotting
something. The Inspector jumped to the conclusion that it was murder
you were hushing up. By that time I had a pretty good notion that it
was the Ravensthorpe family secret. Once I saw that passage of yours,
dwindling away to almost nothing, the thing was clear enough. With the
Fairy House clue as well, the thing was almost certain. And finally,
you gave the show away completely by what you said beside Maurice’s
body.”

“Chuchundra, you mean?”

“Yes. I remembered—another of these docketed trifles—just what
Chuchundra was. He was the muskrat that tried to make up his mind to
run into the middle of the room, but he never got there. Then I asked
you if the trouble began with A. Of course it did. Agoraphobia. I
suppose when Maurice was a kid he had slight attacks of it—hated to
move about in an open room and preferred to sidle along by the walls
if possible. That was the start of the nickname, wasn’t it?”

Cecil assented with a nod.

“It evidently cropped up in your family now and again. Hence the Fairy
Houses—harbours of refuge when attacks came on. And that underground
cell, where a man could shut himself up tight and escape the horror of
open spaces.”

“I’d really no notion how bad it was with Maurice,” Cecil hastened to
say. “It must have been deadly when it drove him to shoot himself.”

“Something beyond description, I should say,” Sir Clinton said,
gravely.

He glanced over the wide prospects of the park and then raised his
eyes to where great luminous clouds were sailing in stately procession
across the blue.

“Looks peaceful, Cecil, doesn’t it? Makes one rather glad to be alive,
when one gets into a scene like this. And yet, to poor Maurice it was
a mere torture-chamber of nausea and torment, a horror that drove him
to burrowing into holes and crannies, anywhere to escape from the
terrors of the open sky. I don’t suppose that we normal people can
even come near the thing in our imaginations. It’s too rum for our
minds—outside everything we know. Poor devil! No wonder he went off
the rails a bit in the end.”



TRANSCRIBER’S NOTES

This transcription follows the text of the edition published by
Grosset & Dunlap in February, 1928. However, the following alterations
have been made to correct what are believed to be unambiguous errors
in the text:

 * “usally” was corrected to “usually” (Chapter I).
 * “sufficent” was corrected to “sufficient” (Chapter I).
 * “inqiringly” was corrected to “inquiringly” (Chapter I).
 * “deadful” was corrected to “dreadful” (Chapter II).
 * “artifical” was corrected to “artificial” (Chapter II).
 * “reassurred” was corrected to “reassured” (Chapter III).
 * “even since” was corrected to “ever since” (Chapter IV).
 * “That’s was” was corrected to “That was” (Chapter VI).
 * “her’s” was corrected to “hers” (Chapter IX).
 * “lot’s of” was corrected to “lots of” (Chapter XI).
 * “Froggart” was corrected to “Froggatt” (Chapter XIII).
 * “spiney” was corrected to “spinney” (Chapter XIV).
 * “orginal” was corrected to “original” (Chapter XIV).
 * “out of question” was corrected to “out of the question”
   (Chapter XV).
 * Three occurrences of mismatched quotation marks were repaired.
 * One occurrence of a missing em dash was repaired.





*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK TRAGEDY AT RAVENSTHORPE ***


    

Updated editions will replace the previous one—the old editions will
be renamed.

Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
States without permission and without paying copyright
royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
Gutenberg™ electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG™
concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
and may not be used if you charge for an eBook, except by following
the terms of the trademark license, including paying royalties for use
of the Project Gutenberg trademark. If you do not charge anything for
copies of this eBook, complying with the trademark license is very
easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose such as creation
of derivative works, reports, performances and research. Project
Gutenberg eBooks may be modified and printed and given away—you may
do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks not protected
by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the trademark
license, especially commercial redistribution.


START: FULL LICENSE

THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE

PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK

To protect the Project Gutenberg™ mission of promoting the free
distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase “Project
Gutenberg”), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
Project Gutenberg™ License available with this file or online at
www.gutenberg.org/license.

Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg™
electronic works

1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg™
electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg™ electronic works in your
possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
Project Gutenberg™ electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person
or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.

1.B. “Project Gutenberg” is a registered trademark. It may only be
used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg™ electronic works
even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
Gutenberg™ electronic works if you follow the terms of this
agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg™
electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.

1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation (“the
Foundation” or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
of Project Gutenberg™ electronic works. Nearly all the individual
works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
that you will support the Project Gutenberg™ mission of promoting
free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg™
works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
Project Gutenberg™ name associated with the work. You can easily
comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg™ License when
you share it without charge with others.

1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
other Project Gutenberg™ work. The Foundation makes no
representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
country other than the United States.

1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:

1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg™ License must appear
prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg™ work (any work
on which the phrase “Project Gutenberg” appears, or with which the
phrase “Project Gutenberg” is associated) is accessed, displayed,
performed, viewed, copied or distributed:

    This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
    other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
    whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms
    of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online
    at www.gutenberg.org. If you
    are not located in the United States, you will have to check the laws
    of the country where you are located before using this eBook.
  
1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg™ electronic work is
derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase “Project
Gutenberg” associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg™
trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.

1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg™ electronic work is posted
with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
will be linked to the Project Gutenberg™ License for all works
posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
beginning of this work.

1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg™
License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg™.

1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
Gutenberg™ License.

1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg™ work in a format
other than “Plain Vanilla ASCII” or other format used in the official
version posted on the official Project Gutenberg™ website
(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original “Plain
Vanilla ASCII” or other form. Any alternate format must include the
full Project Gutenberg™ License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.

1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg™ works
unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.

1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
access to or distributing Project Gutenberg™ electronic works
provided that:

    • You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
        the use of Project Gutenberg™ works calculated using the method
        you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
        to the owner of the Project Gutenberg™ trademark, but he has
        agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
        Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
        within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
        legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
        payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
        Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
        Section 4, “Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
        Literary Archive Foundation.”
    
    • You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
        you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
        does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg™
        License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
        copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
        all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg™
        works.
    
    • You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
        any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
        electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
        receipt of the work.
    
    • You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
        distribution of Project Gutenberg™ works.
    

1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
Gutenberg™ electronic work or group of works on different terms than
are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
from the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the manager of
the Project Gutenberg™ trademark. Contact the Foundation as set
forth in Section 3 below.

1.F.

1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
Gutenberg™ collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg™
electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
contain “Defects,” such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
cannot be read by your equipment.

1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the “Right
of Replacement or Refund” described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
Gutenberg™ trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
Gutenberg™ electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.

1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
without further opportunities to fix the problem.

1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you ‘AS-IS’, WITH NO
OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.

1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
remaining provisions.

1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
providing copies of Project Gutenberg™ electronic works in
accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg™
electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
or any Project Gutenberg™ work, (b) alteration, modification, or
additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg™ work, and (c) any
Defect you cause.

Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg™

Project Gutenberg™ is synonymous with the free distribution of
electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
from people in all walks of life.

Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg™’s
goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg™ collection will
remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
and permanent future for Project Gutenberg™ and future
generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at www.gutenberg.org.

Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation

The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non-profit
501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
Revenue Service. The Foundation’s EIN or federal tax identification
number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
U.S. federal laws and your state’s laws.

The Foundation’s business office is located at 809 North 1500 West,
Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up
to date contact information can be found at the Foundation’s website
and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact

Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
Literary Archive Foundation

Project Gutenberg™ depends upon and cannot survive without widespread
public support and donations to carry out its mission of
increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
freely distributed in machine-readable form accessible by the widest
array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
status with the IRS.

The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular state
visit www.gutenberg.org/donate.

While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
approach us with offers to donate.

International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.

Please check the Project Gutenberg web pages for current donation
methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate.

Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg™ electronic works

Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
Gutenberg™ concept of a library of electronic works that could be
freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
distributed Project Gutenberg™ eBooks with only a loose network of
volunteer support.

Project Gutenberg™ eBooks are often created from several printed
editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
edition.

Most people start at our website which has the main PG search
facility: www.gutenberg.org.

This website includes information about Project Gutenberg™,
including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.